diff options
| author | Werner Koch <[email protected]> | 2013-02-26 15:14:52 +0000 | 
|---|---|---|
| committer | Werner Koch <[email protected]> | 2013-02-26 15:14:52 +0000 | 
| commit | fdcd5736e610cd64e47da73dcafe8bc4a6a67666 (patch) | |
| tree | 4d523b11e4ea00cf85388a273a056ad90adf67b1 /build-aux | |
| parent | Remove included gitlog-to-changelog. (diff) | |
| download | gpgme-fdcd5736e610cd64e47da73dcafe8bc4a6a67666.tar.gz gpgme-fdcd5736e610cd64e47da73dcafe8bc4a6a67666.zip | |
Update helper scripts.
* configure.ac: Use AC_CONFIG_AUX_DIR.  Remove args from
AM_INIT_AUTOMAKE.  Replace AM_CONFIG_HEADER by AC_CONFIG_HEADER.
* compile, config.guess, config.sub, depcomp, install-sh, ltmain.sh
* mkinstalldirs, texinfo.texi: Move to build-aux/ and update from
gnulib (c042abf).
* build-aux/mdate-sh, build-aux/missing: Install via automake -a -c.
Update autogen.sh for changed config dir.
* autogen.sh: Adjust for scripts dir change.  Update W32 toolprefix
list.
Diffstat (limited to '')
| -rwxr-xr-x | build-aux/compile (renamed from compile) | 0 | ||||
| -rwxr-xr-x | build-aux/config.guess (renamed from config.guess) | 0 | ||||
| -rwxr-xr-x | build-aux/config.sub (renamed from config.sub) | 0 | ||||
| -rwxr-xr-x | build-aux/depcomp (renamed from depcomp) | 0 | ||||
| -rwxr-xr-x | build-aux/install-sh (renamed from install-sh) | 0 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | build-aux/ltmain.sh (renamed from ltmain.sh) | 1 | ||||
| -rwxr-xr-x | build-aux/mdate-sh | 225 | ||||
| -rwxr-xr-x | build-aux/missing | 331 | ||||
| -rwxr-xr-x | build-aux/mkinstalldirs (renamed from mkinstalldirs) | 0 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | build-aux/texinfo.tex | 10079 | 
10 files changed, 10635 insertions, 1 deletions
| diff --git a/compile b/build-aux/compile index 9bb997a6..9bb997a6 100755 --- a/compile +++ b/build-aux/compile diff --git a/config.guess b/build-aux/config.guess index d622a44e..d622a44e 100755 --- a/config.guess +++ b/build-aux/config.guess diff --git a/config.sub b/build-aux/config.sub index c894da45..c894da45 100755 --- a/config.sub +++ b/build-aux/config.sub diff --git a/depcomp b/build-aux/depcomp index e5f9736c..e5f9736c 100755 --- a/depcomp +++ b/build-aux/depcomp diff --git a/install-sh b/build-aux/install-sh index a5897de6..a5897de6 100755 --- a/install-sh +++ b/build-aux/install-sh diff --git a/ltmain.sh b/build-aux/ltmain.sh index c7d06c3c..905e09a6 100644 --- a/ltmain.sh +++ b/build-aux/ltmain.sh @@ -9658,4 +9658,3 @@ build_old_libs=`case $build_libtool_libs in yes) echo no;; *) echo yes;; esac`  # sh-indentation:2  # End:  # vi:sw=2 - diff --git a/build-aux/mdate-sh b/build-aux/mdate-sh new file mode 100755 index 00000000..60dc485a --- /dev/null +++ b/build-aux/mdate-sh @@ -0,0 +1,225 @@ +#!/bin/sh +# Get modification time of a file or directory and pretty-print it. + +scriptversion=2010-08-21.06; # UTC + +# Copyright (C) 1995, 1996, 1997, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2007, 2009, 2010 +# Free Software Foundation, Inc. +# written by Ulrich Drepper <[email protected]>, June 1995 +# +# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify +# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by +# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) +# any later version. +# +# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, +# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of +# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the +# GNU General Public License for more details. +# +# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License +# along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. + +# As a special exception to the GNU General Public License, if you +# distribute this file as part of a program that contains a +# configuration script generated by Autoconf, you may include it under +# the same distribution terms that you use for the rest of that program. + +# This file is maintained in Automake, please report +# bugs to <[email protected]> or send patches to +# <[email protected]>. + +if test -n "${ZSH_VERSION+set}" && (emulate sh) >/dev/null 2>&1; then +  emulate sh +  NULLCMD=: +  # Pre-4.2 versions of Zsh do word splitting on ${1+"$@"}, which +  # is contrary to our usage.  Disable this feature. +  alias -g '${1+"$@"}'='"$@"' +  setopt NO_GLOB_SUBST +fi + +case $1 in +  '') +     echo "$0: No file.  Try \`$0 --help' for more information." 1>&2 +     exit 1; +     ;; +  -h | --h*) +    cat <<\EOF +Usage: mdate-sh [--help] [--version] FILE + +Pretty-print the modification day of FILE, in the format: +1 January 1970 + +Report bugs to <[email protected]>. +EOF +    exit $? +    ;; +  -v | --v*) +    echo "mdate-sh $scriptversion" +    exit $? +    ;; +esac + +error () +{ +  echo "$0: $1" >&2 +  exit 1 +} + + +# Prevent date giving response in another language. +LANG=C +export LANG +LC_ALL=C +export LC_ALL +LC_TIME=C +export LC_TIME + +# GNU ls changes its time format in response to the TIME_STYLE +# variable.  Since we cannot assume `unset' works, revert this +# variable to its documented default. +if test "${TIME_STYLE+set}" = set; then +  TIME_STYLE=posix-long-iso +  export TIME_STYLE +fi + +save_arg1=$1 + +# Find out how to get the extended ls output of a file or directory. +if ls -L /dev/null 1>/dev/null 2>&1; then +  ls_command='ls -L -l -d' +else +  ls_command='ls -l -d' +fi +# Avoid user/group names that might have spaces, when possible. +if ls -n /dev/null 1>/dev/null 2>&1; then +  ls_command="$ls_command -n" +fi + +# A `ls -l' line looks as follows on OS/2. +#  drwxrwx---        0 Aug 11  2001 foo +# This differs from Unix, which adds ownership information. +#  drwxrwx---   2 root  root      4096 Aug 11  2001 foo +# +# To find the date, we split the line on spaces and iterate on words +# until we find a month.  This cannot work with files whose owner is a +# user named `Jan', or `Feb', etc.  However, it's unlikely that `/' +# will be owned by a user whose name is a month.  So we first look at +# the extended ls output of the root directory to decide how many +# words should be skipped to get the date. + +# On HPUX /bin/sh, "set" interprets "-rw-r--r--" as options, so the "x" below. +set x`$ls_command /` + +# Find which argument is the month. +month= +command= +until test $month +do +  test $# -gt 0 || error "failed parsing \`$ls_command /' output" +  shift +  # Add another shift to the command. +  command="$command shift;" +  case $1 in +    Jan) month=January; nummonth=1;; +    Feb) month=February; nummonth=2;; +    Mar) month=March; nummonth=3;; +    Apr) month=April; nummonth=4;; +    May) month=May; nummonth=5;; +    Jun) month=June; nummonth=6;; +    Jul) month=July; nummonth=7;; +    Aug) month=August; nummonth=8;; +    Sep) month=September; nummonth=9;; +    Oct) month=October; nummonth=10;; +    Nov) month=November; nummonth=11;; +    Dec) month=December; nummonth=12;; +  esac +done + +test -n "$month" || error "failed parsing \`$ls_command /' output" + +# Get the extended ls output of the file or directory. +set dummy x`eval "$ls_command \"\\\$save_arg1\""` + +# Remove all preceding arguments +eval $command + +# Because of the dummy argument above, month is in $2. +# +# On a POSIX system, we should have +# +# $# = 5 +# $1 = file size +# $2 = month +# $3 = day +# $4 = year or time +# $5 = filename +# +# On Darwin 7.7.0 and 7.6.0, we have +# +# $# = 4 +# $1 = day +# $2 = month +# $3 = year or time +# $4 = filename + +# Get the month. +case $2 in +  Jan) month=January; nummonth=1;; +  Feb) month=February; nummonth=2;; +  Mar) month=March; nummonth=3;; +  Apr) month=April; nummonth=4;; +  May) month=May; nummonth=5;; +  Jun) month=June; nummonth=6;; +  Jul) month=July; nummonth=7;; +  Aug) month=August; nummonth=8;; +  Sep) month=September; nummonth=9;; +  Oct) month=October; nummonth=10;; +  Nov) month=November; nummonth=11;; +  Dec) month=December; nummonth=12;; +esac + +case $3 in +  ???*) day=$1;; +  *) day=$3; shift;; +esac + +# Here we have to deal with the problem that the ls output gives either +# the time of day or the year. +case $3 in +  *:*) set `date`; eval year=\$$# +       case $2 in +	 Jan) nummonthtod=1;; +	 Feb) nummonthtod=2;; +	 Mar) nummonthtod=3;; +	 Apr) nummonthtod=4;; +	 May) nummonthtod=5;; +	 Jun) nummonthtod=6;; +	 Jul) nummonthtod=7;; +	 Aug) nummonthtod=8;; +	 Sep) nummonthtod=9;; +	 Oct) nummonthtod=10;; +	 Nov) nummonthtod=11;; +	 Dec) nummonthtod=12;; +       esac +       # For the first six month of the year the time notation can also +       # be used for files modified in the last year. +       if (expr $nummonth \> $nummonthtod) > /dev/null; +       then +	 year=`expr $year - 1` +       fi;; +  *) year=$3;; +esac + +# The result. +echo $day $month $year + +# Local Variables: +# mode: shell-script +# sh-indentation: 2 +# eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp) +# time-stamp-start: "scriptversion=" +# time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H" +# time-stamp-time-zone: "UTC" +# time-stamp-end: "; # UTC" +# End: diff --git a/build-aux/missing b/build-aux/missing new file mode 100755 index 00000000..86a8fc31 --- /dev/null +++ b/build-aux/missing @@ -0,0 +1,331 @@ +#! /bin/sh +# Common stub for a few missing GNU programs while installing. + +scriptversion=2012-01-06.13; # UTC + +# Copyright (C) 1996, 1997, 1999, 2000, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, +# 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011, 2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc. +# Originally by Fran,cois Pinard <[email protected]>, 1996. + +# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify +# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by +# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) +# any later version. + +# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, +# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of +# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the +# GNU General Public License for more details. + +# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License +# along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. + +# As a special exception to the GNU General Public License, if you +# distribute this file as part of a program that contains a +# configuration script generated by Autoconf, you may include it under +# the same distribution terms that you use for the rest of that program. + +if test $# -eq 0; then +  echo 1>&2 "Try \`$0 --help' for more information" +  exit 1 +fi + +run=: +sed_output='s/.* --output[ =]\([^ ]*\).*/\1/p' +sed_minuso='s/.* -o \([^ ]*\).*/\1/p' + +# In the cases where this matters, `missing' is being run in the +# srcdir already. +if test -f configure.ac; then +  configure_ac=configure.ac +else +  configure_ac=configure.in +fi + +msg="missing on your system" + +case $1 in +--run) +  # Try to run requested program, and just exit if it succeeds. +  run= +  shift +  "$@" && exit 0 +  # Exit code 63 means version mismatch.  This often happens +  # when the user try to use an ancient version of a tool on +  # a file that requires a minimum version.  In this case we +  # we should proceed has if the program had been absent, or +  # if --run hadn't been passed. +  if test $? = 63; then +    run=: +    msg="probably too old" +  fi +  ;; + +  -h|--h|--he|--hel|--help) +    echo "\ +$0 [OPTION]... PROGRAM [ARGUMENT]... + +Handle \`PROGRAM [ARGUMENT]...' for when PROGRAM is missing, or return an +error status if there is no known handling for PROGRAM. + +Options: +  -h, --help      display this help and exit +  -v, --version   output version information and exit +  --run           try to run the given command, and emulate it if it fails + +Supported PROGRAM values: +  aclocal      touch file \`aclocal.m4' +  autoconf     touch file \`configure' +  autoheader   touch file \`config.h.in' +  autom4te     touch the output file, or create a stub one +  automake     touch all \`Makefile.in' files +  bison        create \`y.tab.[ch]', if possible, from existing .[ch] +  flex         create \`lex.yy.c', if possible, from existing .c +  help2man     touch the output file +  lex          create \`lex.yy.c', if possible, from existing .c +  makeinfo     touch the output file +  yacc         create \`y.tab.[ch]', if possible, from existing .[ch] + +Version suffixes to PROGRAM as well as the prefixes \`gnu-', \`gnu', and +\`g' are ignored when checking the name. + +Send bug reports to <[email protected]>." +    exit $? +    ;; + +  -v|--v|--ve|--ver|--vers|--versi|--versio|--version) +    echo "missing $scriptversion (GNU Automake)" +    exit $? +    ;; + +  -*) +    echo 1>&2 "$0: Unknown \`$1' option" +    echo 1>&2 "Try \`$0 --help' for more information" +    exit 1 +    ;; + +esac + +# normalize program name to check for. +program=`echo "$1" | sed ' +  s/^gnu-//; t +  s/^gnu//; t +  s/^g//; t'` + +# Now exit if we have it, but it failed.  Also exit now if we +# don't have it and --version was passed (most likely to detect +# the program).  This is about non-GNU programs, so use $1 not +# $program. +case $1 in +  lex*|yacc*) +    # Not GNU programs, they don't have --version. +    ;; + +  *) +    if test -z "$run" && ($1 --version) > /dev/null 2>&1; then +       # We have it, but it failed. +       exit 1 +    elif test "x$2" = "x--version" || test "x$2" = "x--help"; then +       # Could not run --version or --help.  This is probably someone +       # running `$TOOL --version' or `$TOOL --help' to check whether +       # $TOOL exists and not knowing $TOOL uses missing. +       exit 1 +    fi +    ;; +esac + +# If it does not exist, or fails to run (possibly an outdated version), +# try to emulate it. +case $program in +  aclocal*) +    echo 1>&2 "\ +WARNING: \`$1' is $msg.  You should only need it if +         you modified \`acinclude.m4' or \`${configure_ac}'.  You might want +         to install the \`Automake' and \`Perl' packages.  Grab them from +         any GNU archive site." +    touch aclocal.m4 +    ;; + +  autoconf*) +    echo 1>&2 "\ +WARNING: \`$1' is $msg.  You should only need it if +         you modified \`${configure_ac}'.  You might want to install the +         \`Autoconf' and \`GNU m4' packages.  Grab them from any GNU +         archive site." +    touch configure +    ;; + +  autoheader*) +    echo 1>&2 "\ +WARNING: \`$1' is $msg.  You should only need it if +         you modified \`acconfig.h' or \`${configure_ac}'.  You might want +         to install the \`Autoconf' and \`GNU m4' packages.  Grab them +         from any GNU archive site." +    files=`sed -n 's/^[ ]*A[CM]_CONFIG_HEADER(\([^)]*\)).*/\1/p' ${configure_ac}` +    test -z "$files" && files="config.h" +    touch_files= +    for f in $files; do +      case $f in +      *:*) touch_files="$touch_files "`echo "$f" | +				       sed -e 's/^[^:]*://' -e 's/:.*//'`;; +      *) touch_files="$touch_files $f.in";; +      esac +    done +    touch $touch_files +    ;; + +  automake*) +    echo 1>&2 "\ +WARNING: \`$1' is $msg.  You should only need it if +         you modified \`Makefile.am', \`acinclude.m4' or \`${configure_ac}'. +         You might want to install the \`Automake' and \`Perl' packages. +         Grab them from any GNU archive site." +    find . -type f -name Makefile.am -print | +	   sed 's/\.am$/.in/' | +	   while read f; do touch "$f"; done +    ;; + +  autom4te*) +    echo 1>&2 "\ +WARNING: \`$1' is needed, but is $msg. +         You might have modified some files without having the +         proper tools for further handling them. +         You can get \`$1' as part of \`Autoconf' from any GNU +         archive site." + +    file=`echo "$*" | sed -n "$sed_output"` +    test -z "$file" && file=`echo "$*" | sed -n "$sed_minuso"` +    if test -f "$file"; then +	touch $file +    else +	test -z "$file" || exec >$file +	echo "#! /bin/sh" +	echo "# Created by GNU Automake missing as a replacement of" +	echo "#  $ $@" +	echo "exit 0" +	chmod +x $file +	exit 1 +    fi +    ;; + +  bison*|yacc*) +    echo 1>&2 "\ +WARNING: \`$1' $msg.  You should only need it if +         you modified a \`.y' file.  You may need the \`Bison' package +         in order for those modifications to take effect.  You can get +         \`Bison' from any GNU archive site." +    rm -f y.tab.c y.tab.h +    if test $# -ne 1; then +        eval LASTARG=\${$#} +	case $LASTARG in +	*.y) +	    SRCFILE=`echo "$LASTARG" | sed 's/y$/c/'` +	    if test -f "$SRCFILE"; then +	         cp "$SRCFILE" y.tab.c +	    fi +	    SRCFILE=`echo "$LASTARG" | sed 's/y$/h/'` +	    if test -f "$SRCFILE"; then +	         cp "$SRCFILE" y.tab.h +	    fi +	  ;; +	esac +    fi +    if test ! -f y.tab.h; then +	echo >y.tab.h +    fi +    if test ! -f y.tab.c; then +	echo 'main() { return 0; }' >y.tab.c +    fi +    ;; + +  lex*|flex*) +    echo 1>&2 "\ +WARNING: \`$1' is $msg.  You should only need it if +         you modified a \`.l' file.  You may need the \`Flex' package +         in order for those modifications to take effect.  You can get +         \`Flex' from any GNU archive site." +    rm -f lex.yy.c +    if test $# -ne 1; then +        eval LASTARG=\${$#} +	case $LASTARG in +	*.l) +	    SRCFILE=`echo "$LASTARG" | sed 's/l$/c/'` +	    if test -f "$SRCFILE"; then +	         cp "$SRCFILE" lex.yy.c +	    fi +	  ;; +	esac +    fi +    if test ! -f lex.yy.c; then +	echo 'main() { return 0; }' >lex.yy.c +    fi +    ;; + +  help2man*) +    echo 1>&2 "\ +WARNING: \`$1' is $msg.  You should only need it if +	 you modified a dependency of a manual page.  You may need the +	 \`Help2man' package in order for those modifications to take +	 effect.  You can get \`Help2man' from any GNU archive site." + +    file=`echo "$*" | sed -n "$sed_output"` +    test -z "$file" && file=`echo "$*" | sed -n "$sed_minuso"` +    if test -f "$file"; then +	touch $file +    else +	test -z "$file" || exec >$file +	echo ".ab help2man is required to generate this page" +	exit $? +    fi +    ;; + +  makeinfo*) +    echo 1>&2 "\ +WARNING: \`$1' is $msg.  You should only need it if +         you modified a \`.texi' or \`.texinfo' file, or any other file +         indirectly affecting the aspect of the manual.  The spurious +         call might also be the consequence of using a buggy \`make' (AIX, +         DU, IRIX).  You might want to install the \`Texinfo' package or +         the \`GNU make' package.  Grab either from any GNU archive site." +    # The file to touch is that specified with -o ... +    file=`echo "$*" | sed -n "$sed_output"` +    test -z "$file" && file=`echo "$*" | sed -n "$sed_minuso"` +    if test -z "$file"; then +      # ... or it is the one specified with @setfilename ... +      infile=`echo "$*" | sed 's/.* \([^ ]*\) *$/\1/'` +      file=`sed -n ' +	/^@setfilename/{ +	  s/.* \([^ ]*\) *$/\1/ +	  p +	  q +	}' $infile` +      # ... or it is derived from the source name (dir/f.texi becomes f.info) +      test -z "$file" && file=`echo "$infile" | sed 's,.*/,,;s,.[^.]*$,,'`.info +    fi +    # If the file does not exist, the user really needs makeinfo; +    # let's fail without touching anything. +    test -f $file || exit 1 +    touch $file +    ;; + +  *) +    echo 1>&2 "\ +WARNING: \`$1' is needed, and is $msg. +         You might have modified some files without having the +         proper tools for further handling them.  Check the \`README' file, +         it often tells you about the needed prerequisites for installing +         this package.  You may also peek at any GNU archive site, in case +         some other package would contain this missing \`$1' program." +    exit 1 +    ;; +esac + +exit 0 + +# Local variables: +# eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp) +# time-stamp-start: "scriptversion=" +# time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H" +# time-stamp-time-zone: "UTC" +# time-stamp-end: "; # UTC" +# End: diff --git a/mkinstalldirs b/build-aux/mkinstalldirs index ef7e16fd..ef7e16fd 100755 --- a/mkinstalldirs +++ b/build-aux/mkinstalldirs diff --git a/build-aux/texinfo.tex b/build-aux/texinfo.tex new file mode 100644 index 00000000..26f732e1 --- /dev/null +++ b/build-aux/texinfo.tex @@ -0,0 +1,10079 @@ +% texinfo.tex -- TeX macros to handle Texinfo files. +% +% Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex. +\expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname\endcsname\relax\input plain\fi +% +\def\texinfoversion{2013-02-25.14} +% +% Copyright 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, +% 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, +% 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011, 2012, 2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc. +% +% This texinfo.tex file is free software: you can redistribute it and/or +% modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as +% published by the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the +% License, or (at your option) any later version. +% +% This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be +% useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty +% of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU +% General Public License for more details. +% +% You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License +% along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. +% +% As a special exception, when this file is read by TeX when processing +% a Texinfo source document, you may use the result without +% restriction. This Exception is an additional permission under section 7 +% of the GNU General Public License, version 3 ("GPLv3"). +% +% Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug +% reports; you can get the latest version from: +%   http://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/texinfo/ (the Texinfo release area), or +%   http://ftpmirror.gnu.org/texinfo/ (same, via a mirror), or +%   http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo/ (the Texinfo home page) +% The texinfo.tex in any given distribution could well be out +% of date, so if that's what you're using, please check. +% +% Send bug reports to [email protected].  Please include including a +% complete document in each bug report with which we can reproduce the +% problem.  Patches are, of course, greatly appreciated. +% +% To process a Texinfo manual with TeX, it's most reliable to use the +% texi2dvi shell script that comes with the distribution.  For a simple +% manual foo.texi, however, you can get away with this: +%   tex foo.texi +%   texindex foo.?? +%   tex foo.texi +%   tex foo.texi +%   dvips foo.dvi -o  # or whatever; this makes foo.ps. +% The extra TeX runs get the cross-reference information correct. +% Sometimes one run after texindex suffices, and sometimes you need more +% than two; texi2dvi does it as many times as necessary. +% +% It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages, to some +% extent.  You can get the existing language-specific files from the +% full Texinfo distribution. +% +% The GNU Texinfo home page is http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo. + + +\message{Loading texinfo [version \texinfoversion]:} + +% If in a .fmt file, print the version number +% and turn on active characters that we couldn't do earlier because +% they might have appeared in the input file name. +\everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}% +  \catcode`+=\active \catcode`\_=\active} + +\chardef\other=12 + +% We never want plain's \outer definition of \+ in Texinfo. +% For @tex, we can use \tabalign. +\let\+ = \relax + +% Save some plain tex macros whose names we will redefine. +\let\ptexb=\b +\let\ptexbullet=\bullet +\let\ptexc=\c +\let\ptexcomma=\, +\let\ptexdot=\. +\let\ptexdots=\dots +\let\ptexend=\end +\let\ptexequiv=\equiv +\let\ptexexclam=\! +\let\ptexfootnote=\footnote +\let\ptexgtr=> +\let\ptexhat=^ +\let\ptexi=\i +\let\ptexindent=\indent +\let\ptexinsert=\insert +\let\ptexlbrace=\{ +\let\ptexless=< +\let\ptexnewwrite\newwrite +\let\ptexnoindent=\noindent +\let\ptexplus=+ +\let\ptexraggedright=\raggedright +\let\ptexrbrace=\} +\let\ptexslash=\/ +\let\ptexstar=\* +\let\ptext=\t +\let\ptextop=\top +{\catcode`\'=\active \global\let\ptexquoteright'}% active in plain's math mode + +% If this character appears in an error message or help string, it +% starts a new line in the output. +\newlinechar = `^^J + +% Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error +% messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. +% +\ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined +  \let\linenumber = \empty % Pre-3.0. +\else +  \def\linenumber{l.\the\inputlineno:\space} +\fi + +% Set up fixed words for English if not already set. +\ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined  \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}\fi +\ifx\putwordChapter\undefined   \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter}\fi +\ifx\putworderror\undefined     \gdef\putworderror{error}\fi +\ifx\putwordfile\undefined      \gdef\putwordfile{file}\fi +\ifx\putwordin\undefined        \gdef\putwordin{in}\fi +\ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined       \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)}\fi +\ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined   \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)}\fi +\ifx\putwordInfo\undefined      \gdef\putwordInfo{Info}\fi +\ifx\putwordInstanceVariableof\undefined \gdef\putwordInstanceVariableof{Instance Variable of}\fi +\ifx\putwordMethodon\undefined  \gdef\putwordMethodon{Method on}\fi +\ifx\putwordNoTitle\undefined   \gdef\putwordNoTitle{No Title}\fi +\ifx\putwordof\undefined        \gdef\putwordof{of}\fi +\ifx\putwordon\undefined        \gdef\putwordon{on}\fi +\ifx\putwordpage\undefined      \gdef\putwordpage{page}\fi +\ifx\putwordsection\undefined   \gdef\putwordsection{section}\fi +\ifx\putwordSection\undefined   \gdef\putwordSection{Section}\fi +\ifx\putwordsee\undefined       \gdef\putwordsee{see}\fi +\ifx\putwordSee\undefined       \gdef\putwordSee{See}\fi +\ifx\putwordShortTOC\undefined  \gdef\putwordShortTOC{Short Contents}\fi +\ifx\putwordTOC\undefined       \gdef\putwordTOC{Table of Contents}\fi +% +\ifx\putwordMJan\undefined \gdef\putwordMJan{January}\fi +\ifx\putwordMFeb\undefined \gdef\putwordMFeb{February}\fi +\ifx\putwordMMar\undefined \gdef\putwordMMar{March}\fi +\ifx\putwordMApr\undefined \gdef\putwordMApr{April}\fi +\ifx\putwordMMay\undefined \gdef\putwordMMay{May}\fi +\ifx\putwordMJun\undefined \gdef\putwordMJun{June}\fi +\ifx\putwordMJul\undefined \gdef\putwordMJul{July}\fi +\ifx\putwordMAug\undefined \gdef\putwordMAug{August}\fi +\ifx\putwordMSep\undefined \gdef\putwordMSep{September}\fi +\ifx\putwordMOct\undefined \gdef\putwordMOct{October}\fi +\ifx\putwordMNov\undefined \gdef\putwordMNov{November}\fi +\ifx\putwordMDec\undefined \gdef\putwordMDec{December}\fi +% +\ifx\putwordDefmac\undefined    \gdef\putwordDefmac{Macro}\fi +\ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined   \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form}\fi +\ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined    \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable}\fi +\ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined    \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option}\fi +\ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined   \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function}\fi + +% Since the category of space is not known, we have to be careful. +\chardef\spacecat = 10 +\def\spaceisspace{\catcode`\ =\spacecat} + +% sometimes characters are active, so we need control sequences. +\chardef\ampChar   = `\& +\chardef\colonChar = `\: +\chardef\commaChar = `\, +\chardef\dashChar  = `\- +\chardef\dotChar   = `\. +\chardef\exclamChar= `\! +\chardef\hashChar  = `\# +\chardef\lquoteChar= `\` +\chardef\questChar = `\? +\chardef\rquoteChar= `\' +\chardef\semiChar  = `\; +\chardef\slashChar = `\/ +\chardef\underChar = `\_ + +% Ignore a token. +% +\def\gobble#1{} + +% The following is used inside several \edef's. +\def\makecsname#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname} + +% Hyphenation fixes. +\hyphenation{ +  Flor-i-da Ghost-script Ghost-view Mac-OS Post-Script +  ap-pen-dix bit-map bit-maps +  data-base data-bases eshell fall-ing half-way long-est man-u-script +  man-u-scripts mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers over-view par-a-digm +  par-a-digms rath-er rec-tan-gu-lar ro-bot-ics se-vere-ly set-up spa-ces +  spell-ing spell-ings +  stand-alone strong-est time-stamp time-stamps which-ever white-space +  wide-spread wrap-around +} + +% Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages. +\newdimen\bindingoffset +\newdimen\normaloffset +\newdimen\pagewidth \newdimen\pageheight + +% For a final copy, take out the rectangles +% that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided +% that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin). +% +\def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt } + +% Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file +% and nothing on the terminal.  We don't just call \tracingall here, +% since that produces some useless output on the terminal.  We also make +% some effort to order the tracing commands to reduce output in the log +% file; cf. trace.sty in LaTeX. +% +\def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs = 1 \loggingall \endgroup}% +\def\loggingall{% +  \tracingstats2 +  \tracingpages1 +  \tracinglostchars2  % 2 gives us more in etex +  \tracingparagraphs1 +  \tracingoutput1 +  \tracingmacros2 +  \tracingrestores1 +  \showboxbreadth\maxdimen \showboxdepth\maxdimen +  \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined\else % etex gives us more logging +    \tracingscantokens1 +    \tracingifs1 +    \tracinggroups1 +    \tracingnesting2 +    \tracingassigns1 +  \fi +  \tracingcommands3  % 3 gives us more in etex +  \errorcontextlines16 +}% + +% @errormsg{MSG}.  Do the index-like expansions on MSG, but if things +% aren't perfect, it's not the end of the world, being an error message, +% after all. +% +\def\errormsg{\begingroup \indexnofonts \doerrormsg} +\def\doerrormsg#1{\errmessage{#1}} + +% add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions.  If the last thing +% we did was a \nobreak, we don't want to insert more space. +% +\def\smallbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\smallskipamount +  \removelastskip\penalty-50\smallskip\fi\fi} +\def\medbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\medskipamount +  \removelastskip\penalty-100\medskip\fi\fi} +\def\bigbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\bigskipamount +  \removelastskip\penalty-200\bigskip\fi\fi} + +% Do @cropmarks to get crop marks. +% +\newif\ifcropmarks +\let\cropmarks = \cropmarkstrue +% +% Dimensions to add cropmarks at corners. +% Added by P. A. MacKay, 12 Nov. 1986 +% +\newdimen\outerhsize \newdimen\outervsize % set by the paper size routines +\newdimen\cornerlong  \cornerlong=1pc +\newdimen\cornerthick \cornerthick=.3pt +\newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=.75in + +% Output a mark which sets \thischapter, \thissection and \thiscolor. +% We dump everything together because we only have one kind of mark. +% This works because we only use \botmark / \topmark, not \firstmark. +% +% A mark contains a subexpression of the \ifcase ... \fi construct. +% \get*marks macros below extract the needed part using \ifcase. +% +% Another complication is to let the user choose whether \thischapter +% (\thissection) refers to the chapter (section) in effect at the top +% of a page, or that at the bottom of a page.  The solution is +% described on page 260 of The TeXbook.  It involves outputting two +% marks for the sectioning macros, one before the section break, and +% one after.  I won't pretend I can describe this better than DEK... +\def\domark{% +  \toks0=\expandafter{\lastchapterdefs}% +  \toks2=\expandafter{\lastsectiondefs}% +  \toks4=\expandafter{\prevchapterdefs}% +  \toks6=\expandafter{\prevsectiondefs}% +  \toks8=\expandafter{\lastcolordefs}% +  \mark{% +                   \the\toks0 \the\toks2 +      \noexpand\or \the\toks4 \the\toks6 +    \noexpand\else \the\toks8 +  }% +} +% \topmark doesn't work for the very first chapter (after the title +% page or the contents), so we use \firstmark there -- this gets us +% the mark with the chapter defs, unless the user sneaks in, e.g., +% @setcolor (or @url, or @link, etc.) between @contents and the very +% first @chapter. +\def\gettopheadingmarks{% +  \ifcase0\topmark\fi +  \ifx\thischapter\empty \ifcase0\firstmark\fi \fi +} +\def\getbottomheadingmarks{\ifcase1\botmark\fi} +\def\getcolormarks{\ifcase2\topmark\fi} + +% Avoid "undefined control sequence" errors. +\def\lastchapterdefs{} +\def\lastsectiondefs{} +\def\prevchapterdefs{} +\def\prevsectiondefs{} +\def\lastcolordefs{} + +% Main output routine. +\chardef\PAGE = 255 +\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}} + +\newbox\headlinebox +\newbox\footlinebox + +% \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument.  Note that \pagecontents +% does insertions, but you have to call it yourself. +\def\onepageout#1{% +  \ifcropmarks \hoffset=0pt \else \hoffset=\normaloffset \fi +  % +  \ifodd\pageno  \advance\hoffset by \bindingoffset +  \else \advance\hoffset by -\bindingoffset\fi +  % +  % Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in +  % the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code). +  \ifodd\pageno \getoddheadingmarks \else \getevenheadingmarks \fi +  \setbox\headlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makeheadline}% +  \ifodd\pageno \getoddfootingmarks \else \getevenfootingmarks \fi +  \setbox\footlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makefootline}% +  % +  {% +    % Have to do this stuff outside the \shipout because we want it to +    % take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends +    % before the \shipout runs. +    % +    \indexdummies         % don't expand commands in the output. +    \normalturnoffactive  % \ in index entries must not stay \, e.g., if +               % the page break happens to be in the middle of an example. +               % We don't want .vr (or whatever) entries like this: +               % \entry{{\tt \indexbackslash }acronym}{32}{\code {\acronym}} +               % "\acronym" won't work when it's read back in; +               % it needs to be +               % {\code {{\tt \backslashcurfont }acronym} +    \shipout\vbox{% +      % Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page. +      \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfdest name{\the\pageno} xyz\fi +      % +      \ifcropmarks \vbox to \outervsize\bgroup +        \hsize = \outerhsize +        \vskip-\topandbottommargin +        \vtop to0pt{% +          \line{\ewtop\hfil\ewtop}% +          \nointerlineskip +          \line{% +            \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nstop}% +            \hfill +            \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nstop}% +          }% +          \vss}% +        \vskip\topandbottommargin +        \line\bgroup +          \hfil % center the page within the outer (page) hsize. +          \ifodd\pageno\hskip\bindingoffset\fi +          \vbox\bgroup +      \fi +      % +      \unvbox\headlinebox +      \pagebody{#1}% +      \ifdim\ht\footlinebox > 0pt +        % Only leave this space if the footline is nonempty. +        % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingyyy.) +        % The \baselineskip=24pt in plain's \makefootline has no effect. +        \vskip 24pt +        \unvbox\footlinebox +      \fi +      % +      \ifcropmarks +          \egroup % end of \vbox\bgroup +        \hfil\egroup % end of (centering) \line\bgroup +        \vskip\topandbottommargin plus1fill minus1fill +        \boxmaxdepth = \cornerthick +        \vbox to0pt{\vss +          \line{% +            \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nsbot}% +            \hfill +            \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nsbot}% +          }% +          \nointerlineskip +          \line{\ewbot\hfil\ewbot}% +        }% +      \egroup % \vbox from first cropmarks clause +      \fi +    }% end of \shipout\vbox +  }% end of group with \indexdummies +  \advancepageno +  \ifnum\outputpenalty>-20000 \else\dosupereject\fi +} + +\newinsert\margin \dimen\margin=\maxdimen + +\def\pagebody#1{\vbox to\pageheight{\boxmaxdepth=\maxdepth #1}} +{\catcode`\@ =11 +\gdef\pagecontents#1{\ifvoid\topins\else\unvbox\topins\fi +% marginal hacks, [email protected] (Juha Takala) +\ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present +  \rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to\z@{\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi +\dimen@=\dp#1\relax \unvbox#1\relax +\ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi +\ifr@ggedbottom \kern-\dimen@ \vfil \fi} +} + +% Here are the rules for the cropmarks.  Note that they are +% offset so that the space between them is truly \outerhsize or \outervsize +% (P. A. MacKay, 12 November, 1986) +% +\def\ewtop{\vrule height\cornerthick depth0pt width\cornerlong} +\def\nstop{\vbox +  {\hrule height\cornerthick depth\cornerlong width\cornerthick}} +\def\ewbot{\vrule height0pt depth\cornerthick width\cornerlong} +\def\nsbot{\vbox +  {\hrule height\cornerlong depth\cornerthick width\cornerthick}} + +% Parse an argument, then pass it to #1.  The argument is the rest of +% the input line (except we remove a trailing comment).  #1 should be a +% macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument. +% +\def\parsearg{\parseargusing{}} +\def\parseargusing#1#2{% +  \def\argtorun{#2}% +  \begingroup +    \obeylines +    \spaceisspace +    #1% +    \parseargline\empty% Insert the \empty token, see \finishparsearg below. +} + +{\obeylines % +  \gdef\parseargline#1^^M{% +    \endgroup % End of the group started in \parsearg. +    \argremovecomment #1\comment\ArgTerm% +  }% +} + +% First remove any @comment, then any @c comment. +\def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\ArgTerm{\argremovec #1\c\ArgTerm} +\def\argremovec#1\c#2\ArgTerm{\argcheckspaces#1\^^M\ArgTerm} + +% Each occurrence of `\^^M' or `<space>\^^M' is replaced by a single space. +% +% \argremovec might leave us with trailing space, e.g., +%    @end itemize  @c foo +% This space token undergoes the same procedure and is eventually removed +% by \finishparsearg. +% +\def\argcheckspaces#1\^^M{\argcheckspacesX#1\^^M \^^M} +\def\argcheckspacesX#1 \^^M{\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M} +\def\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M#2\^^M#3\ArgTerm{% +  \def\temp{#3}% +  \ifx\temp\empty +    % Do not use \next, perhaps the caller of \parsearg uses it; reuse \temp: +    \let\temp\finishparsearg +  \else +    \let\temp\argcheckspaces +  \fi +  % Put the space token in: +  \temp#1 #3\ArgTerm +} + +% If a _delimited_ argument is enclosed in braces, they get stripped; so +% to get _exactly_ the rest of the line, we had to prevent such situation. +% We prepended an \empty token at the very beginning and we expand it now, +% just before passing the control to \argtorun. +% (Similarly, we have to think about #3 of \argcheckspacesY above: it is +% either the null string, or it ends with \^^M---thus there is no danger +% that a pair of braces would be stripped. +% +% But first, we have to remove the trailing space token. +% +\def\finishparsearg#1 \ArgTerm{\expandafter\argtorun\expandafter{#1}} + +% \parseargdef\foo{...} +%	is roughly equivalent to +% \def\foo{\parsearg\Xfoo} +% \def\Xfoo#1{...} +% +% Actually, I use \csname\string\foo\endcsname, ie. \\foo, as it is my +% favourite TeX trick.  --kasal, 16nov03 + +\def\parseargdef#1{% +  \expandafter \doparseargdef \csname\string#1\endcsname #1% +} +\def\doparseargdef#1#2{% +  \def#2{\parsearg#1}% +  \def#1##1% +} + +% Several utility definitions with active space: +{ +  \obeyspaces +  \gdef\obeyedspace{ } + +  % Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword +  % space in the output.  Don't allow a line break at this space, as this +  % is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input +  % should produce a line of output anyway. +  % +  \gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\tie} + +  % If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces +  % therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the +  % expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \@M \ ). +  \gdef\unsepspaces{\let =\space} +} + + +\def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next##1{}\else \let\next=\relax \fi \next} + +% Define the framework for environments in texinfo.tex.  It's used like this: +% +%   \envdef\foo{...} +%   \def\Efoo{...} +% +% It's the responsibility of \envdef to insert \begingroup before the +% actual body; @end closes the group after calling \Efoo.  \envdef also +% defines \thisenv, so the current environment is known; @end checks +% whether the environment name matches.  The \checkenv macro can also be +% used to check whether the current environment is the one expected. +% +% Non-false conditionals (@iftex, @ifset) don't fit into this, so they +% are not treated as environments; they don't open a group.  (The +% implementation of @end takes care not to call \endgroup in this +% special case.) + + +% At run-time, environments start with this: +\def\startenvironment#1{\begingroup\def\thisenv{#1}} +% initialize +\let\thisenv\empty + +% ... but they get defined via ``\envdef\foo{...}'': +\long\def\envdef#1#2{\def#1{\startenvironment#1#2}} +\def\envparseargdef#1#2{\parseargdef#1{\startenvironment#1#2}} + +% Check whether we're in the right environment: +\def\checkenv#1{% +  \def\temp{#1}% +  \ifx\thisenv\temp +  \else +    \badenverr +  \fi +} + +% Environment mismatch, #1 expected: +\def\badenverr{% +  \errhelp = \EMsimple +  \errmessage{This command can appear only \inenvironment\temp, +    not \inenvironment\thisenv}% +} +\def\inenvironment#1{% +  \ifx#1\empty +    outside of any environment% +  \else +    in environment \expandafter\string#1% +  \fi +} + +% @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo. +% But first, it executes a specialized version of \checkenv +% +\parseargdef\end{% +  \if 1\csname iscond.#1\endcsname +  \else +    % The general wording of \badenverr may not be ideal. +    \expandafter\checkenv\csname#1\endcsname +    \csname E#1\endcsname +    \endgroup +  \fi +} + +\newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.} + + +% Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space +% equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space +% at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and +% since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the +% penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph. +{\catcode`@ = 11 + % Avoid using \@M directly, because that causes trouble + % if the definition is written into an index file. + \global\let\tiepenalty = \@M + \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\tiepenalty\ } +} + +% @: forces normal size whitespace following. +\def\:{\spacefactor=1000 } + +% @* forces a line break. +\def\*{\unskip\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces} + +% @/ allows a line break. +\let\/=\allowbreak + +% @. is an end-of-sentence period. +\def\.{.\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space} + +% @! is an end-of-sentence bang. +\def\!{!\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space} + +% @? is an end-of-sentence query. +\def\?{?\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space} + +% @frenchspacing on|off  says whether to put extra space after punctuation. +% +\def\onword{on} +\def\offword{off} +% +\parseargdef\frenchspacing{% +  \def\temp{#1}% +  \ifx\temp\onword \plainfrenchspacing +  \else\ifx\temp\offword \plainnonfrenchspacing +  \else +    \errhelp = \EMsimple +    \errmessage{Unknown @frenchspacing option `\temp', must be on|off}% +  \fi\fi +} + +% @w prevents a word break.  Without the \leavevmode, @w at the +% beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would +% produce a whole line of output instead of starting the paragraph. +\def\w#1{\leavevmode\hbox{#1}} + +% @group ... @end group forces ... to be all on one page, by enclosing +% it in a TeX vbox.  We use \vtop instead of \vbox to construct the box +% to keep its height that of a normal line.  According to the rules for +% \topskip (p.114 of the TeXbook), the glue inserted is +% max (\topskip - \ht (first item), 0).  If that height is large, +% therefore, no glue is inserted, and the space between the headline and +% the text is small, which looks bad. +% +% Another complication is that the group might be very large.  This can +% cause the glue on the previous page to be unduly stretched, because it +% does not have much material.  In this case, it's better to add an +% explicit \vfill so that the extra space is at the bottom.  The +% threshold for doing this is if the group is more than \vfilllimit +% percent of a page (\vfilllimit can be changed inside of @tex). +% +\newbox\groupbox +\def\vfilllimit{0.7} +% +\envdef\group{% +  \ifnum\catcode`\^^M=\active \else +    \errhelp = \groupinvalidhelp +    \errmessage{@group invalid in context where filling is enabled}% +  \fi +  \startsavinginserts +  % +  \setbox\groupbox = \vtop\bgroup +    % Do @comment since we are called inside an environment such as +    % @example, where each end-of-line in the input causes an +    % end-of-line in the output.  We don't want the end-of-line after +    % the `@group' to put extra space in the output.  Since @group +    % should appear on a line by itself (according to the Texinfo +    % manual), we don't worry about eating any user text. +    \comment +} +% +% The \vtop produces a box with normal height and large depth; thus, TeX puts +% \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the next line of text is done) +% \lineskip glue after it.  Thus, space below is not quite equal to space +% above.  But it's pretty close. +\def\Egroup{% +    % To get correct interline space between the last line of the group +    % and the first line afterwards, we have to propagate \prevdepth. +    \endgraf % Not \par, as it may have been set to \lisppar. +    \global\dimen1 = \prevdepth +  \egroup           % End the \vtop. +  % \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box. +  \dimen0 = \ht\groupbox  \advance\dimen0 by \dp\groupbox +  % \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less). +  \dimen2 = \pageheight   \advance\dimen2 by -\pagetotal +  % if the group doesn't fit on the current page, and it's a big big +  % group, force a page break. +  \ifdim \dimen0 > \dimen2 +    \ifdim \pagetotal < \vfilllimit\pageheight +      \page +    \fi +  \fi +  \box\groupbox +  \prevdepth = \dimen1 +  \checkinserts +} +% +% TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help +% message, so this ends up printing `@group can only ...'. +% +\newhelp\groupinvalidhelp{% +group can only be used in environments such as @example,^^J% +where each line of input produces a line of output.} + +% @need space-in-mils +% forces a page break if there is not space-in-mils remaining. + +\newdimen\mil  \mil=0.001in + +\parseargdef\need{% +  % Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a +  % paragraph. +  \par +  % +  % If the @need value is less than one line space, it's useless. +  \dimen0 = #1\mil +  \dimen2 = \ht\strutbox +  \advance\dimen2 by \dp\strutbox +  \ifdim\dimen0 > \dimen2 +    % +    % Do a \strut just to make the height of this box be normal, so the +    % normal leading is inserted relative to the preceding line. +    % And a page break here is fine. +    \vtop to #1\mil{\strut\vfil}% +    % +    % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the +    % main vertical list is 10000 or more.  But in order to see if the +    % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider +    % page breaks.  On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the +    % page after the empty box.  So we use a penalty of 9999. +    % +    % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the +    % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in +    % sight.  (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which +    % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing +    % good page breaking, for example.)  However, I could not construct an +    % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real +    % document, then we can reconsider our strategy. +    \penalty9999 +    % +    % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not. +    \kern -#1\mil +    % +    % Do not allow a page break right after this kern. +    \nobreak +  \fi +} + +% @br   forces paragraph break (and is undocumented). + +\let\br = \par + +% @page forces the start of a new page. +% +\def\page{\par\vfill\supereject} + +% @exdent text.... +% outputs text on separate line in roman font, starting at standard page margin + +% This records the amount of indent in the innermost environment. +% That's how much \exdent should take out. +\newskip\exdentamount + +% This defn is used inside fill environments such as @defun. +\parseargdef\exdent{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break} + +% This defn is used inside nofill environments such as @example. +\parseargdef\nofillexdent{{\advance \leftskip by -\exdentamount +  \leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}} + +% @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current +% paragraph.  For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion +% class.  WHICH is `l' or `r'.  Not documented, written for gawk manual. +% +\newskip\inmarginspacing \inmarginspacing=1cm +\def\strutdepth{\dp\strutbox} +% +\def\doinmargin#1#2{\strut\vadjust{% +  \nobreak +  \kern-\strutdepth +  \vtop to \strutdepth{% +    \baselineskip=\strutdepth +    \vss +    % if you have multiple lines of stuff to put here, you'll need to +    % make the vbox yourself of the appropriate size. +    \ifx#1l% +      \llap{\ignorespaces #2\hskip\inmarginspacing}% +    \else +      \rlap{\hskip\hsize \hskip\inmarginspacing \ignorespaces #2}% +    \fi +    \null +  }% +}} +\def\inleftmargin{\doinmargin l} +\def\inrightmargin{\doinmargin r} +% +% @inmargin{TEXT [, RIGHT-TEXT]} +% (if RIGHT-TEXT is given, use TEXT for left page, RIGHT-TEXT for right; +% else use TEXT for both). +% +\def\inmargin#1{\parseinmargin #1,,\finish} +\def\parseinmargin#1,#2,#3\finish{% not perfect, but better than nothing. +  \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% +  \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt +    \def\lefttext{#1}%  have both texts +    \def\righttext{#2}% +  \else +    \def\lefttext{#1}%  have only one text +    \def\righttext{#1}% +  \fi +  % +  \ifodd\pageno +    \def\temp{\inrightmargin\righttext}% odd page -> outside is right margin +  \else +    \def\temp{\inleftmargin\lefttext}% +  \fi +  \temp +} + +% @| inserts a changebar to the left of the current line.  It should +% surround any changed text.  This approach does *not* work if the +% change spans more than two lines of output.  To handle that, we would +% have adopt a much more difficult approach (putting marks into the main +% vertical list for the beginning and end of each change).  This command +% is not documented, not supported, and doesn't work. +% +\def\|{% +  % \vadjust can only be used in horizontal mode. +  \leavevmode +  % +  % Append this vertical mode material after the current line in the output. +  \vadjust{% +    % We want to insert a rule with the height and depth of the current +    % leading; that is exactly what \strutbox is supposed to record. +    \vskip-\baselineskip +    % +    % \vadjust-items are inserted at the left edge of the type.  So +    % the \llap here moves out into the left-hand margin. +    \llap{% +      % +      % For a thicker or thinner bar, change the `1pt'. +      \vrule height\baselineskip width1pt +      % +      % This is the space between the bar and the text. +      \hskip 12pt +    }% +  }% +} + +% @include FILE -- \input text of FILE. +% +\def\include{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\includezzz} +\def\includezzz#1{% +  \pushthisfilestack +  \def\thisfile{#1}% +  {% +    \makevalueexpandable  % we want to expand any @value in FILE. +    \turnoffactive        % and allow special characters in the expansion +    \indexnofonts         % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names. +    \wlog{texinfo.tex: doing @include of #1^^J}% +    \edef\temp{\noexpand\input #1 }% +    % +    % This trickery is to read FILE outside of a group, in case it makes +    % definitions, etc. +    \expandafter +  }\temp +  \popthisfilestack +} +\def\filenamecatcodes{% +  \catcode`\\=\other +  \catcode`~=\other +  \catcode`^=\other +  \catcode`_=\other +  \catcode`|=\other +  \catcode`<=\other +  \catcode`>=\other +  \catcode`+=\other +  \catcode`-=\other +  \catcode`\`=\other +  \catcode`\'=\other +} + +\def\pushthisfilestack{% +  \expandafter\pushthisfilestackX\popthisfilestack\StackTerm +} +\def\pushthisfilestackX{% +  \expandafter\pushthisfilestackY\thisfile\StackTerm +} +\def\pushthisfilestackY #1\StackTerm #2\StackTerm {% +  \gdef\popthisfilestack{\gdef\thisfile{#1}\gdef\popthisfilestack{#2}}% +} + +\def\popthisfilestack{\errthisfilestackempty} +\def\errthisfilestackempty{\errmessage{Internal error: +  the stack of filenames is empty.}} +% +\def\thisfile{} + +% @center line +% outputs that line, centered. +% +\parseargdef\center{% +  \ifhmode +    \let\centersub\centerH +  \else +    \let\centersub\centerV +  \fi +  \centersub{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}% +  \let\centersub\relax % don't let the definition persist, just in case +} +\def\centerH#1{{% +  \hfil\break +  \advance\hsize by -\leftskip +  \advance\hsize by -\rightskip +  \line{#1}% +  \break +}} +% +\newcount\centerpenalty +\def\centerV#1{% +  % The idea here is the same as in \startdefun, \cartouche, etc.: if +  % @center is the first thing after a section heading, we need to wipe +  % out the negative parskip inserted by \sectionheading, but still +  % prevent a page break here. +  \centerpenalty = \lastpenalty +  \ifnum\centerpenalty>10000 \vskip\parskip \fi +  \ifnum\centerpenalty>9999 \penalty\centerpenalty \fi +  \line{\kern\leftskip #1\kern\rightskip}% +} + +% @sp n   outputs n lines of vertical space +% +\parseargdef\sp{\vskip #1\baselineskip} + +% @comment ...line which is ignored... +% @c is the same as @comment +% @ignore ... @end ignore  is another way to write a comment +% +\def\comment{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=\other% +\catcode`\@=\other \catcode`\{=\other \catcode`\}=\other% +\commentxxx} +{\catcode`\^^M=\other \gdef\commentxxx#1^^M{\endgroup}} +% +\let\c=\comment + +% @paragraphindent NCHARS +% We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough. +% NCHARS can also be the word `asis' or `none'. +% We cannot feasibly implement @paragraphindent asis, though. +% +\def\asisword{asis} % no translation, these are keywords +\def\noneword{none} +% +\parseargdef\paragraphindent{% +  \def\temp{#1}% +  \ifx\temp\asisword +  \else +    \ifx\temp\noneword +      \defaultparindent = 0pt +    \else +      \defaultparindent = #1em +    \fi +  \fi +  \parindent = \defaultparindent +} + +% @exampleindent NCHARS +% We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent. +% It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but +% I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent. +\parseargdef\exampleindent{% +  \def\temp{#1}% +  \ifx\temp\asisword +  \else +    \ifx\temp\noneword +      \lispnarrowing = 0pt +    \else +      \lispnarrowing = #1em +    \fi +  \fi +} + +% @firstparagraphindent WORD +% If WORD is `none', then suppress indentation of the first paragraph +% after a section heading.  If WORD is `insert', then do indent at such +% paragraphs. +% +% The paragraph indentation is suppressed or not by calling +% \suppressfirstparagraphindent, which the sectioning commands do. +% We switch the definition of this back and forth according to WORD. +% By default, we suppress indentation. +% +\def\suppressfirstparagraphindent{\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent} +\def\insertword{insert} +% +\parseargdef\firstparagraphindent{% +  \def\temp{#1}% +  \ifx\temp\noneword +    \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \dosuppressfirstparagraphindent +  \else\ifx\temp\insertword +    \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \relax +  \else +    \errhelp = \EMsimple +    \errmessage{Unknown @firstparagraphindent option `\temp'}% +  \fi\fi +} + +% Here is how we actually suppress indentation.  Redefine \everypar to +% \kern backwards by \parindent, and then reset itself to empty. +% +% We also make \indent itself not actually do anything until the next +% paragraph. +% +\gdef\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent{% +  \gdef\indent{% +    \restorefirstparagraphindent +    \indent +  }% +  \gdef\noindent{% +    \restorefirstparagraphindent +    \noindent +  }% +  \global\everypar = {% +    \kern -\parindent +    \restorefirstparagraphindent +  }% +} + +\gdef\restorefirstparagraphindent{% +  \global \let \indent = \ptexindent +  \global \let \noindent = \ptexnoindent +  \global \everypar = {}% +} + + +% @refill is a no-op. +\let\refill=\relax + +% If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to +% be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs. +% This is done with @novalidate (before @setfilename). +% +\newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files. +\let\novalidate = \linksfalse + +% @setfilename is done at the beginning of every texinfo file. +% So open here the files we need to have open while reading the input. +% This makes it possible to make a .fmt file for texinfo. +\def\setfilename{% +   \fixbackslash  % Turn off hack to swallow `\input texinfo'. +   \iflinks +     \tryauxfile +     % Open the new aux file.  TeX will close it automatically at exit. +     \immediate\openout\auxfile=\jobname.aux +   \fi % \openindices needs to do some work in any case. +   \openindices +   \let\setfilename=\comment % Ignore extra @setfilename cmds. +   % +   % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it. +   % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc. +   \openin 1 texinfo.cnf +   \ifeof 1 \else \input texinfo.cnf \fi +   \closein 1 +   % +   \comment % Ignore the actual filename. +} + +% Called from \setfilename. +% +\def\openindices{% +  \newindex{cp}% +  \newcodeindex{fn}% +  \newcodeindex{vr}% +  \newcodeindex{tp}% +  \newcodeindex{ky}% +  \newcodeindex{pg}% +} + +% @bye. +\outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=1\ptexend} + + +\message{pdf,} +% adobe `portable' document format +\newcount\tempnum +\newcount\lnkcount +\newtoks\filename +\newcount\filenamelength +\newcount\pgn +\newtoks\toksA +\newtoks\toksB +\newtoks\toksC +\newtoks\toksD +\newbox\boxA +\newcount\countA +\newif\ifpdf +\newif\ifpdfmakepagedest + +% when pdftex is run in dvi mode, \pdfoutput is defined (so \pdfoutput=1 +% can be set).  So we test for \relax and 0 as well as being undefined. +\ifx\pdfoutput\thisisundefined +\else +  \ifx\pdfoutput\relax +  \else +    \ifcase\pdfoutput +    \else +      \pdftrue +    \fi +  \fi +\fi + +% PDF uses PostScript string constants for the names of xref targets, +% for display in the outlines, and in other places.  Thus, we have to +% double any backslashes.  Otherwise, a name like "\node" will be +% interpreted as a newline (\n), followed by o, d, e.  Not good. +% +% See http://www.ntg.nl/pipermail/ntg-pdftex/2004-July/000654.html and +% related messages.  The final outcome is that it is up to the TeX user +% to double the backslashes and otherwise make the string valid, so +% that's what we do.  pdftex 1.30.0 (ca.2005) introduced a primitive to +% do this reliably, so we use it. + +% #1 is a control sequence in which to do the replacements, +% which we \xdef. +\def\txiescapepdf#1{% +  \ifx\pdfescapestring\thisisundefined +    % No primitive available; should we give a warning or log? +    % Many times it won't matter. +  \else +    % The expandable \pdfescapestring primitive escapes parentheses, +    % backslashes, and other special chars. +    \xdef#1{\pdfescapestring{#1}}% +  \fi +} + +\newhelp\nopdfimagehelp{Texinfo supports .png, .jpg, .jpeg, and .pdf images +with PDF output, and none of those formats could be found.  (.eps cannot +be supported due to the design of the PDF format; use regular TeX (DVI +output) for that.)} + +\ifpdf +  % +  % Color manipulation macros based on pdfcolor.tex, +  % except using rgb instead of cmyk; the latter is said to render as a +  % very dark gray on-screen and a very dark halftone in print, instead +  % of actual black. +  \def\rgbDarkRed{0.50 0.09 0.12} +  \def\rgbBlack{0 0 0} +  % +  % k sets the color for filling (usual text, etc.); +  % K sets the color for stroking (thin rules, e.g., normal _'s). +  \def\pdfsetcolor#1{\pdfliteral{#1 rg  #1 RG}} +  % +  % Set color, and create a mark which defines \thiscolor accordingly, +  % so that \makeheadline knows which color to restore. +  \def\setcolor#1{% +    \xdef\lastcolordefs{\gdef\noexpand\thiscolor{#1}}% +    \domark +    \pdfsetcolor{#1}% +  } +  % +  \def\maincolor{\rgbBlack} +  \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor} +  \edef\thiscolor{\maincolor} +  \def\lastcolordefs{} +  % +  \def\makefootline{% +    \baselineskip24pt +    \line{\pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\footline}% +  } +  % +  \def\makeheadline{% +    \vbox to 0pt{% +      \vskip-22.5pt +      \line{% +        \vbox to8.5pt{}% +        % Extract \thiscolor definition from the marks. +        \getcolormarks +        % Typeset the headline with \maincolor, then restore the color. +        \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\headline\pdfsetcolor{\thiscolor}% +      }% +      \vss +    }% +    \nointerlineskip +  } +  % +  % +  \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines} +  % +  % #1 is image name, #2 width (might be empty/whitespace), #3 height (ditto). +  \def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{% +    \def\pdfimagewidth{#2}\setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% +    \def\pdfimageheight{#3}\setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}% +    % +    % pdftex (and the PDF format) support .pdf, .png, .jpg (among +    % others).  Let's try in that order, PDF first since if +    % someone has a scalable image, presumably better to use that than a +    % bitmap. +    \let\pdfimgext=\empty +    \begingroup +      \openin 1 #1.pdf \ifeof 1 +        \openin 1 #1.PDF \ifeof 1 +          \openin 1 #1.png \ifeof 1 +            \openin 1 #1.jpg \ifeof 1 +              \openin 1 #1.jpeg \ifeof 1 +                \openin 1 #1.JPG \ifeof 1 +                  \errhelp = \nopdfimagehelp +                  \errmessage{Could not find image file #1 for pdf}% +                \else \gdef\pdfimgext{JPG}% +                \fi +              \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpeg}% +              \fi +            \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpg}% +            \fi +          \else \gdef\pdfimgext{png}% +          \fi +        \else \gdef\pdfimgext{PDF}% +        \fi +      \else \gdef\pdfimgext{pdf}% +      \fi +      \closein 1 +    \endgroup +    % +    % without \immediate, ancient pdftex seg faults when the same image is +    % included twice.  (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.) +    \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 +      \immediate\pdfimage +    \else +      \immediate\pdfximage +    \fi +      \ifdim \wd0 >0pt width \pdfimagewidth \fi +      \ifdim \wd2 >0pt height \pdfimageheight \fi +      \ifnum\pdftexversion<13 +         #1.\pdfimgext +       \else +         {#1.\pdfimgext}% +       \fi +    \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 \else +      \pdfrefximage \pdflastximage +    \fi} +  % +  \def\pdfmkdest#1{{% +    % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code, and characters +    % such as \, aren't expanded when present in a section title. +    \indexnofonts +    \turnoffactive +    \makevalueexpandable +    \def\pdfdestname{#1}% +    \txiescapepdf\pdfdestname +    \safewhatsit{\pdfdest name{\pdfdestname} xyz}% +  }} +  % +  % used to mark target names; must be expandable. +  \def\pdfmkpgn#1{#1} +  % +  % by default, use a color that is dark enough to print on paper as +  % nearly black, but still distinguishable for online viewing. +  \def\urlcolor{\rgbDarkRed} +  \def\linkcolor{\rgbDarkRed} +  \def\endlink{\setcolor{\maincolor}\pdfendlink} +  % +  % Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines +  % come from Petr Olsak +  \def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0% +    \else \csname#1\endcsname \fi} +  \def\advancenumber#1{\tempnum=\expnumber{#1}\relax +    \advance\tempnum by 1 +    \expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}} +  % +  % #1 is the section text, which is what will be displayed in the +  % outline by the pdf viewer.  #2 is the pdf expression for the number +  % of subentries (or empty, for subsubsections).  #3 is the node text, +  % which might be empty if this toc entry had no corresponding node. +  % #4 is the page number +  % +  \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{% +    % Generate a link to the node text if that exists; else, use the +    % page number.  We could generate a destination for the section +    % text in the case where a section has no node, but it doesn't +    % seem worth the trouble, since most documents are normally structured. +    \edef\pdfoutlinedest{#3}% +    \ifx\pdfoutlinedest\empty +      \def\pdfoutlinedest{#4}% +    \else +      \txiescapepdf\pdfoutlinedest +    \fi +    % +    % Also escape PDF chars in the display string. +    \edef\pdfoutlinetext{#1}% +    \txiescapepdf\pdfoutlinetext +    % +    \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfoutlinedest}}#2{\pdfoutlinetext}% +  } +  % +  \def\pdfmakeoutlines{% +    \begingroup +      % Read toc silently, to get counts of subentries for \pdfoutline. +      \def\partentry##1##2##3##4{}% ignore parts in the outlines +      \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{% +	\def\thischapnum{##2}% +	\def\thissecnum{0}% +	\def\thissubsecnum{0}% +      }% +      \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{% +	\advancenumber{chap\thischapnum}% +	\def\thissecnum{##2}% +	\def\thissubsecnum{0}% +      }% +      \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% +	\advancenumber{sec\thissecnum}% +	\def\thissubsecnum{##2}% +      }% +      \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% +	\advancenumber{subsec\thissubsecnum}% +      }% +      \def\thischapnum{0}% +      \def\thissecnum{0}% +      \def\thissubsecnum{0}% +      % +      % use \def rather than \let here because we redefine \chapentry et +      % al. a second time, below. +      \def\appentry{\numchapentry}% +      \def\appsecentry{\numsecentry}% +      \def\appsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}% +      \def\appsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}% +      \def\unnchapentry{\numchapentry}% +      \def\unnsecentry{\numsecentry}% +      \def\unnsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}% +      \def\unnsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}% +      \readdatafile{toc}% +      % +      % Read toc second time, this time actually producing the outlines. +      % The `-' means take the \expnumber as the absolute number of +      % subentries, which we calculated on our first read of the .toc above. +      % +      % We use the node names as the destinations. +      \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{% +        \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{chap##2}}{##3}{##4}}% +      \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{% +        \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{sec##2}}{##3}{##4}}% +      \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% +        \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{subsec##2}}{##3}{##4}}% +      \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% count is always zero +        \dopdfoutline{##1}{}{##3}{##4}}% +      % +      % PDF outlines are displayed using system fonts, instead of +      % document fonts.  Therefore we cannot use special characters, +      % since the encoding is unknown.  For example, the eogonek from +      % Latin 2 (0xea) gets translated to a | character.  Info from +      % Staszek Wawrykiewicz, 19 Jan 2004 04:09:24 +0100. +      % +      % TODO this right, we have to translate 8-bit characters to +      % their "best" equivalent, based on the @documentencoding.  Too +      % much work for too little return.  Just use the ASCII equivalents +      % we use for the index sort strings. +      % +      \indexnofonts +      \setupdatafile +      % We can have normal brace characters in the PDF outlines, unlike +      % Texinfo index files.  So set that up. +      \def\{{\lbracecharliteral}% +      \def\}{\rbracecharliteral}% +      \catcode`\\=\active \otherbackslash +      \input \tocreadfilename +    \endgroup +  } +  {\catcode`[=1 \catcode`]=2 +   \catcode`{=\other \catcode`}=\other +   \gdef\lbracecharliteral[{]% +   \gdef\rbracecharliteral[}]% +  ] +  % +  \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}% +    \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax +    \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces +      \addtokens{\filename}{\PP}% +      \advance\filenamelength by 1 +    \fi +    \nextsp} +  \def\getfilename#1{% +    \filenamelength=0 +    % If we don't expand the argument now, \skipspaces will get +    % snagged on things like "@value{foo}". +    \edef\temp{#1}% +    \expandafter\skipspaces\temp|\relax +  } +  \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 +    \let \startlink \pdfannotlink +  \else +    \let \startlink \pdfstartlink +  \fi +  % make a live url in pdf output. +  \def\pdfurl#1{% +    \begingroup +      % it seems we really need yet another set of dummies; have not +      % tried to figure out what each command should do in the context +      % of @url.  for now, just make @/ a no-op, that's the only one +      % people have actually reported a problem with. +      % +      \normalturnoffactive +      \def\@{@}% +      \let\/=\empty +      \makevalueexpandable +      % do we want to go so far as to use \indexnofonts instead of just +      % special-casing \var here? +      \def\var##1{##1}% +      % +      \leavevmode\setcolor{\urlcolor}% +      \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}% +        user{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >>}% +    \endgroup} +  \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}} +  \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks} +  \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks} +  \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}} +  \def\maketoks{% +    \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|\relax +    \ifx\first0\adn0 +    \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3 +    \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6 +    \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9 +    \else +      \ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi +      \ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else +        \let\next=\maketoks +        \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD} +        \ifx\first,\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi +      \fi +    \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi +    \next} +  \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}% +    {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0} +  \def\pdflink#1{% +    \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}} +    \setcolor{\linkcolor}#1\endlink} +  \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st} +\else +  % non-pdf mode +  \let\pdfmkdest = \gobble +  \let\pdfurl = \gobble +  \let\endlink = \relax +  \let\setcolor = \gobble +  \let\pdfsetcolor = \gobble +  \let\pdfmakeoutlines = \relax +\fi  % \ifx\pdfoutput + + +\message{fonts,} + +% Change the current font style to #1, remembering it in \curfontstyle. +% For now, we do not accumulate font styles: @b{@i{foo}} prints foo in +% italics, not bold italics. +% +\def\setfontstyle#1{% +  \def\curfontstyle{#1}% not as a control sequence, because we are \edef'd. +  \csname ten#1\endcsname  % change the current font +} + +% Select #1 fonts with the current style. +% +\def\selectfonts#1{\csname #1fonts\endcsname \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname} + +\def\rm{\fam=0 \setfontstyle{rm}} +\def\it{\fam=\itfam \setfontstyle{it}} +\def\sl{\fam=\slfam \setfontstyle{sl}} +\def\bf{\fam=\bffam \setfontstyle{bf}}\def\bfstylename{bf} +\def\tt{\fam=\ttfam \setfontstyle{tt}} + +% Unfortunately, we have to override this for titles and the like, since +% in those cases "rm" is bold.  Sigh. +\def\rmisbold{\rm\def\curfontstyle{bf}} + +% Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not. +% So we set up a \sf. +\newfam\sffam +\def\sf{\fam=\sffam \setfontstyle{sf}} +\let\li = \sf % Sometimes we call it \li, not \sf. + +% We don't need math for this font style. +\def\ttsl{\setfontstyle{ttsl}} + + +% Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size +% correspondingly.  There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers +% used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined. +% +\def\lineskipfactor{.08333} +\def\strutheightpercent{.70833} +\def\strutdepthpercent {.29167} +% +% can get a sort of poor man's double spacing by redefining this. +\def\baselinefactor{1} +% +\newdimen\textleading +\def\setleading#1{% +  \dimen0 = #1\relax +  \normalbaselineskip = \baselinefactor\dimen0 +  \normallineskip = \lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip +  \normalbaselines +  \setbox\strutbox =\hbox{% +    \vrule width0pt height\strutheightpercent\baselineskip +                    depth \strutdepthpercent \baselineskip +  }% +} + +% PDF CMaps.  See also LaTeX's t1.cmap. +% +% do nothing with this by default. +\expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1\endcsname\gobble +\expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname\gobble +\expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname\gobble + +% if we are producing pdf, and we have \pdffontattr, then define cmaps. +% (\pdffontattr was introduced many years ago, but people still run +% older pdftex's; it's easy to conditionalize, so we do.) +\ifpdf \ifx\pdffontattr\thisisundefined \else +  \begingroup +    \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char. +    \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap +%%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit) +%%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit) +%%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1-0) +%%Title: (TeX-OT1-0 TeX OT1 0) +%%Version: 1.000 +%%EndComments +/CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin +12 dict begin +begincmap +/CIDSystemInfo +<< /Registry (TeX) +/Ordering (OT1) +/Supplement 0 +>> def +/CMapName /TeX-OT1-0 def +/CMapType 2 def +1 begincodespacerange +<00> <7F> +endcodespacerange +8 beginbfrange +<00> <01> <0393> +<09> <0A> <03A8> +<23> <26> <0023> +<28> <3B> <0028> +<3F> <5B> <003F> +<5D> <5E> <005D> +<61> <7A> <0061> +<7B> <7C> <2013> +endbfrange +40 beginbfchar +<02> <0398> +<03> <039B> +<04> <039E> +<05> <03A0> +<06> <03A3> +<07> <03D2> +<08> <03A6> +<0B> <00660066> +<0C> <00660069> +<0D> <0066006C> +<0E> <006600660069> +<0F> <00660066006C> +<10> <0131> +<11> <0237> +<12> <0060> +<13> <00B4> +<14> <02C7> +<15> <02D8> +<16> <00AF> +<17> <02DA> +<18> <00B8> +<19> <00DF> +<1A> <00E6> +<1B> <0153> +<1C> <00F8> +<1D> <00C6> +<1E> <0152> +<1F> <00D8> +<21> <0021> +<22> <201D> +<27> <2019> +<3C> <00A1> +<3D> <003D> +<3E> <00BF> +<5C> <201C> +<5F> <02D9> +<60> <2018> +<7D> <02DD> +<7E> <007E> +<7F> <00A8> +endbfchar +endcmap +CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop +end +end +%%EndResource +%%EOF +    }\endgroup +  \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1\endcsname#1{% +    \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}% +  }% +% +% \cmapOT1IT +  \begingroup +    \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char. +    \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap +%%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit) +%%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit) +%%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1IT-0) +%%Title: (TeX-OT1IT-0 TeX OT1IT 0) +%%Version: 1.000 +%%EndComments +/CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin +12 dict begin +begincmap +/CIDSystemInfo +<< /Registry (TeX) +/Ordering (OT1IT) +/Supplement 0 +>> def +/CMapName /TeX-OT1IT-0 def +/CMapType 2 def +1 begincodespacerange +<00> <7F> +endcodespacerange +8 beginbfrange +<00> <01> <0393> +<09> <0A> <03A8> +<25> <26> <0025> +<28> <3B> <0028> +<3F> <5B> <003F> +<5D> <5E> <005D> +<61> <7A> <0061> +<7B> <7C> <2013> +endbfrange +42 beginbfchar +<02> <0398> +<03> <039B> +<04> <039E> +<05> <03A0> +<06> <03A3> +<07> <03D2> +<08> <03A6> +<0B> <00660066> +<0C> <00660069> +<0D> <0066006C> +<0E> <006600660069> +<0F> <00660066006C> +<10> <0131> +<11> <0237> +<12> <0060> +<13> <00B4> +<14> <02C7> +<15> <02D8> +<16> <00AF> +<17> <02DA> +<18> <00B8> +<19> <00DF> +<1A> <00E6> +<1B> <0153> +<1C> <00F8> +<1D> <00C6> +<1E> <0152> +<1F> <00D8> +<21> <0021> +<22> <201D> +<23> <0023> +<24> <00A3> +<27> <2019> +<3C> <00A1> +<3D> <003D> +<3E> <00BF> +<5C> <201C> +<5F> <02D9> +<60> <2018> +<7D> <02DD> +<7E> <007E> +<7F> <00A8> +endbfchar +endcmap +CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop +end +end +%%EndResource +%%EOF +    }\endgroup +  \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname#1{% +    \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}% +  }% +% +% \cmapOT1TT +  \begingroup +    \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char. +    \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap +%%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit) +%%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit) +%%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1TT-0) +%%Title: (TeX-OT1TT-0 TeX OT1TT 0) +%%Version: 1.000 +%%EndComments +/CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin +12 dict begin +begincmap +/CIDSystemInfo +<< /Registry (TeX) +/Ordering (OT1TT) +/Supplement 0 +>> def +/CMapName /TeX-OT1TT-0 def +/CMapType 2 def +1 begincodespacerange +<00> <7F> +endcodespacerange +5 beginbfrange +<00> <01> <0393> +<09> <0A> <03A8> +<21> <26> <0021> +<28> <5F> <0028> +<61> <7E> <0061> +endbfrange +32 beginbfchar +<02> <0398> +<03> <039B> +<04> <039E> +<05> <03A0> +<06> <03A3> +<07> <03D2> +<08> <03A6> +<0B> <2191> +<0C> <2193> +<0D> <0027> +<0E> <00A1> +<0F> <00BF> +<10> <0131> +<11> <0237> +<12> <0060> +<13> <00B4> +<14> <02C7> +<15> <02D8> +<16> <00AF> +<17> <02DA> +<18> <00B8> +<19> <00DF> +<1A> <00E6> +<1B> <0153> +<1C> <00F8> +<1D> <00C6> +<1E> <0152> +<1F> <00D8> +<20> <2423> +<27> <2019> +<60> <2018> +<7F> <00A8> +endbfchar +endcmap +CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop +end +end +%%EndResource +%%EOF +    }\endgroup +  \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname#1{% +    \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}% +  }% +\fi\fi + + +% Set the font macro #1 to the font named \fontprefix#2. +% #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor, #5 is the CMap +% encoding (only OT1, OT1IT and OT1TT are allowed, or empty to omit). +% Example: +% #1 = \textrm +% #2 = \rmshape +% #3 = 10 +% #4 = \mainmagstep +% #5 = OT1 +% +\def\setfont#1#2#3#4#5{% +  \font#1=\fontprefix#2#3 scaled #4 +  \csname cmap#5\endcsname#1% +} +% This is what gets called when #5 of \setfont is empty. +\let\cmap\gobble +% +% (end of cmaps) + +% Use cm as the default font prefix. +% To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix +% before you read in texinfo.tex. +\ifx\fontprefix\thisisundefined +\def\fontprefix{cm} +\fi +% Support font families that don't use the same naming scheme as CM. +\def\rmshape{r} +\def\rmbshape{bx}               % where the normal face is bold +\def\bfshape{b} +\def\bxshape{bx} +\def\ttshape{tt} +\def\ttbshape{tt} +\def\ttslshape{sltt} +\def\itshape{ti} +\def\itbshape{bxti} +\def\slshape{sl} +\def\slbshape{bxsl} +\def\sfshape{ss} +\def\sfbshape{ss} +\def\scshape{csc} +\def\scbshape{csc} + +% Definitions for a main text size of 11pt.  (The default in Texinfo.) +% +\def\definetextfontsizexi{% +% Text fonts (11.2pt, magstep1). +\def\textnominalsize{11pt} +\edef\mainmagstep{\magstephalf} +\setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} +\setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT} +\setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} +\setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT} +\setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} +\setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} +\setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} +\setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT} +\font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep +\font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep +\def\textecsize{1095} + +% A few fonts for @defun names and args. +\setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1} +\setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT} +\setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT} +\def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf} + +% Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt). +\def\smallnominalsize{9pt} +\setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1} +\setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT} +\setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1} +\setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT} +\setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1} +\setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1} +\setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1} +\setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT} +\font\smalli=cmmi9 +\font\smallsy=cmsy9 +\def\smallecsize{0900} + +% Fonts for small examples (8pt). +\def\smallernominalsize{8pt} +\setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1} +\setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT} +\setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1} +\setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT} +\setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1} +\setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1} +\setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1} +\setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT} +\font\smalleri=cmmi8 +\font\smallersy=cmsy8 +\def\smallerecsize{0800} + +% Fonts for title page (20.4pt): +\def\titlenominalsize{20pt} +\setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1} +\setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT} +\setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1} +\setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT} +\setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT} +\setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1} +\let\titlebf=\titlerm +\setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1} +\font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3 +\font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4 +\def\titleecsize{2074} + +% Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt). +\def\chapnominalsize{17pt} +\setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1} +\setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1IT} +\setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1} +\setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1TT} +\setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1TT} +\setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000}{OT1} +\let\chapbf=\chaprm +\setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1} +\font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep2 +\font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep3 +\def\chapecsize{1728} + +% Section fonts (14.4pt). +\def\secnominalsize{14pt} +\setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1} +\setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT} +\setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1} +\setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT} +\setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT} +\setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1} +\let\secbf\secrm +\setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1} +\font\seci=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1 +\font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2 +\def\sececsize{1440} + +% Subsection fonts (13.15pt). +\def\ssecnominalsize{13pt} +\setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1} +\setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315}{OT1IT} +\setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315}{OT1} +\setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT} +\setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315}{OT1TT} +\setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1} +\let\ssecbf\ssecrm +\setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1315}{OT1} +\font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled \magstephalf +\font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled 1315 +\def\ssececsize{1200} + +% Reduced fonts for @acro in text (10pt). +\def\reducednominalsize{10pt} +\setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{10}{1000}{OT1} +\setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT} +\setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{1000}{OT1} +\setfont\reducedit\itshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT} +\setfont\reducedsl\slshape{10}{1000}{OT1} +\setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{10}{1000}{OT1} +\setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{1000}{OT1} +\setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT} +\font\reducedi=cmmi10 +\font\reducedsy=cmsy10 +\def\reducedecsize{1000} + +\textleading = 13.2pt % line spacing for 11pt CM +\textfonts            % reset the current fonts +\rm +} % end of 11pt text font size definitions, \definetextfontsizexi + + +% Definitions to make the main text be 10pt Computer Modern, with +% section, chapter, etc., sizes following suit.  This is for the GNU +% Press printing of the Emacs 22 manual.  Maybe other manuals in the +% future.  Used with @smallbook, which sets the leading to 12pt. +% +\def\definetextfontsizex{% +% Text fonts (10pt). +\def\textnominalsize{10pt} +\edef\mainmagstep{1000} +\setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} +\setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT} +\setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} +\setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT} +\setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} +\setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} +\setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} +\setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT} +\font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep +\font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep +\def\textecsize{1000} + +% A few fonts for @defun names and args. +\setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1} +\setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT} +\setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT} +\def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf} + +% Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt). +\def\smallnominalsize{9pt} +\setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1} +\setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT} +\setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1} +\setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT} +\setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1} +\setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1} +\setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1} +\setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT} +\font\smalli=cmmi9 +\font\smallsy=cmsy9 +\def\smallecsize{0900} + +% Fonts for small examples (8pt). +\def\smallernominalsize{8pt} +\setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1} +\setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT} +\setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1} +\setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT} +\setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1} +\setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1} +\setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1} +\setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT} +\font\smalleri=cmmi8 +\font\smallersy=cmsy8 +\def\smallerecsize{0800} + +% Fonts for title page (20.4pt): +\def\titlenominalsize{20pt} +\setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1} +\setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT} +\setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1} +\setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT} +\setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT} +\setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1} +\let\titlebf=\titlerm +\setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1} +\font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3 +\font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4 +\def\titleecsize{2074} + +% Chapter fonts (14.4pt). +\def\chapnominalsize{14pt} +\setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1} +\setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT} +\setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1} +\setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT} +\setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT} +\setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1} +\let\chapbf\chaprm +\setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1} +\font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1 +\font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2 +\def\chapecsize{1440} + +% Section fonts (12pt). +\def\secnominalsize{12pt} +\setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{1000}{OT1} +\setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1IT} +\setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1} +\setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT} +\setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT} +\setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{1000}{OT1} +\let\secbf\secrm +\setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1} +\font\seci=cmmi12 +\font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep1 +\def\sececsize{1200} + +% Subsection fonts (10pt). +\def\ssecnominalsize{10pt} +\setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{10}{1000}{OT1} +\setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT} +\setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1000}{OT1} +\setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT} +\setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT} +\setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{10}{1000}{OT1} +\let\ssecbf\ssecrm +\setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1000}{OT1} +\font\sseci=cmmi10 +\font\ssecsy=cmsy10 +\def\ssececsize{1000} + +% Reduced fonts for @acro in text (9pt). +\def\reducednominalsize{9pt} +\setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1} +\setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT} +\setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1} +\setfont\reducedit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT} +\setfont\reducedsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1} +\setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1} +\setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1} +\setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT} +\font\reducedi=cmmi9 +\font\reducedsy=cmsy9 +\def\reducedecsize{0900} + +\divide\parskip by 2  % reduce space between paragraphs +\textleading = 12pt   % line spacing for 10pt CM +\textfonts            % reset the current fonts +\rm +} % end of 10pt text font size definitions, \definetextfontsizex + + +% We provide the user-level command +%   @fonttextsize 10 +% (or 11) to redefine the text font size.  pt is assumed. +% +\def\xiword{11} +\def\xword{10} +\def\xwordpt{10pt} +% +\parseargdef\fonttextsize{% +  \def\textsizearg{#1}% +  %\wlog{doing @fonttextsize \textsizearg}% +  % +  % Set \globaldefs so that documents can use this inside @tex, since +  % makeinfo 4.8 does not support it, but we need it nonetheless. +  % + \begingroup \globaldefs=1 +  \ifx\textsizearg\xword \definetextfontsizex +  \else \ifx\textsizearg\xiword \definetextfontsizexi +  \else +    \errhelp=\EMsimple +    \errmessage{@fonttextsize only supports `10' or `11', not `\textsizearg'} +  \fi\fi + \endgroup +} + + +% In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters, +% we have to define the \textfont of the standard families.  Since +% texinfo doesn't allow for producing subscripts and superscripts except +% in the main text, we don't bother to reset \scriptfont and +% \scriptscriptfont (which would also require loading a lot more fonts). +% +\def\resetmathfonts{% +  \textfont0=\tenrm \textfont1=\teni \textfont2=\tensy +  \textfont\itfam=\tenit \textfont\slfam=\tensl \textfont\bffam=\tenbf +  \textfont\ttfam=\tentt \textfont\sffam=\tensf +} + +% The font-changing commands redefine the meanings of \tenSTYLE, instead +% of just \STYLE.  We do this because \STYLE needs to also set the +% current \fam for math mode.  Our \STYLE (e.g., \rm) commands hardwire +% \tenSTYLE to set the current font. +% +% Each font-changing command also sets the names \lsize (one size lower) +% and \lllsize (three sizes lower).  These relative commands are used in +% the LaTeX logo and acronyms. +% +% This all needs generalizing, badly. +% +\def\textfonts{% +  \let\tenrm=\textrm \let\tenit=\textit \let\tensl=\textsl +  \let\tenbf=\textbf \let\tentt=\texttt \let\smallcaps=\textsc +  \let\tensf=\textsf \let\teni=\texti \let\tensy=\textsy +  \let\tenttsl=\textttsl +  \def\curfontsize{text}% +  \def\lsize{reduced}\def\lllsize{smaller}% +  \resetmathfonts \setleading{\textleading}} +\def\titlefonts{% +  \let\tenrm=\titlerm \let\tenit=\titleit \let\tensl=\titlesl +  \let\tenbf=\titlebf \let\tentt=\titlett \let\smallcaps=\titlesc +  \let\tensf=\titlesf \let\teni=\titlei \let\tensy=\titlesy +  \let\tenttsl=\titlettsl +  \def\curfontsize{title}% +  \def\lsize{chap}\def\lllsize{subsec}% +  \resetmathfonts \setleading{27pt}} +\def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rmisbold #1}} +\def\chapfonts{% +  \let\tenrm=\chaprm \let\tenit=\chapit \let\tensl=\chapsl +  \let\tenbf=\chapbf \let\tentt=\chaptt \let\smallcaps=\chapsc +  \let\tensf=\chapsf \let\teni=\chapi \let\tensy=\chapsy +  \let\tenttsl=\chapttsl +  \def\curfontsize{chap}% +  \def\lsize{sec}\def\lllsize{text}% +  \resetmathfonts \setleading{19pt}} +\def\secfonts{% +  \let\tenrm=\secrm \let\tenit=\secit \let\tensl=\secsl +  \let\tenbf=\secbf \let\tentt=\sectt \let\smallcaps=\secsc +  \let\tensf=\secsf \let\teni=\seci \let\tensy=\secsy +  \let\tenttsl=\secttsl +  \def\curfontsize{sec}% +  \def\lsize{subsec}\def\lllsize{reduced}% +  \resetmathfonts \setleading{16pt}} +\def\subsecfonts{% +  \let\tenrm=\ssecrm \let\tenit=\ssecit \let\tensl=\ssecsl +  \let\tenbf=\ssecbf \let\tentt=\ssectt \let\smallcaps=\ssecsc +  \let\tensf=\ssecsf \let\teni=\sseci \let\tensy=\ssecsy +  \let\tenttsl=\ssecttsl +  \def\curfontsize{ssec}% +  \def\lsize{text}\def\lllsize{small}% +  \resetmathfonts \setleading{15pt}} +\let\subsubsecfonts = \subsecfonts +\def\reducedfonts{% +  \let\tenrm=\reducedrm \let\tenit=\reducedit \let\tensl=\reducedsl +  \let\tenbf=\reducedbf \let\tentt=\reducedtt \let\reducedcaps=\reducedsc +  \let\tensf=\reducedsf \let\teni=\reducedi \let\tensy=\reducedsy +  \let\tenttsl=\reducedttsl +  \def\curfontsize{reduced}% +  \def\lsize{small}\def\lllsize{smaller}% +  \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}} +\def\smallfonts{% +  \let\tenrm=\smallrm \let\tenit=\smallit \let\tensl=\smallsl +  \let\tenbf=\smallbf \let\tentt=\smalltt \let\smallcaps=\smallsc +  \let\tensf=\smallsf \let\teni=\smalli \let\tensy=\smallsy +  \let\tenttsl=\smallttsl +  \def\curfontsize{small}% +  \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}% +  \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}} +\def\smallerfonts{% +  \let\tenrm=\smallerrm \let\tenit=\smallerit \let\tensl=\smallersl +  \let\tenbf=\smallerbf \let\tentt=\smallertt \let\smallcaps=\smallersc +  \let\tensf=\smallersf \let\teni=\smalleri \let\tensy=\smallersy +  \let\tenttsl=\smallerttsl +  \def\curfontsize{smaller}% +  \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}% +  \resetmathfonts \setleading{9.5pt}} + +% Fonts for short table of contents. +\setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000}{OT1} +\setfont\shortcontbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}  % no cmb12 +\setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000}{OT1} +\setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT} + +% Define these just so they can be easily changed for other fonts. +\def\angleleft{$\langle$} +\def\angleright{$\rangle$} + +% Set the fonts to use with the @small... environments. +\let\smallexamplefonts = \smallfonts + +% About \smallexamplefonts.  If we use \smallfonts (9pt), @smallexample +% can fit this many characters: +%   8.5x11=86   smallbook=72  a4=90  a5=69 +% If we use \scriptfonts (8pt), then we can fit this many characters: +%   8.5x11=90+  smallbook=80  a4=90+  a5=77 +% For me, subjectively, the few extra characters that fit aren't worth +% the additional smallness of 8pt.  So I'm making the default 9pt. +% +% By the way, for comparison, here's what fits with @example (10pt): +%   8.5x11=71  smallbook=60  a4=75  a5=58 +% --karl, 24jan03. + +% Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes. +% +\definetextfontsizexi + + +\message{markup,} + +% Check if we are currently using a typewriter font.  Since all the +% Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and +% shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all typewriter fonts to have +% this property, we can check that font parameter. +% +\def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=0pt } + +% Markup style infrastructure.  \defmarkupstylesetup\INITMACRO will +% define and register \INITMACRO to be called on markup style changes. +% \INITMACRO can check \currentmarkupstyle for the innermost +% style and the set of \ifmarkupSTYLE switches for all styles +% currently in effect. +\newif\ifmarkupvar +\newif\ifmarkupsamp +\newif\ifmarkupkey +%\newif\ifmarkupfile % @file == @samp. +%\newif\ifmarkupoption % @option == @samp. +\newif\ifmarkupcode +\newif\ifmarkupkbd +%\newif\ifmarkupenv % @env == @code. +%\newif\ifmarkupcommand % @command == @code. +\newif\ifmarkuptex % @tex (and part of @math, for now). +\newif\ifmarkupexample +\newif\ifmarkupverb +\newif\ifmarkupverbatim + +\let\currentmarkupstyle\empty + +\def\setupmarkupstyle#1{% +  \csname markup#1true\endcsname +  \def\currentmarkupstyle{#1}% +  \markupstylesetup +} + +\let\markupstylesetup\empty + +\def\defmarkupstylesetup#1{% +  \expandafter\def\expandafter\markupstylesetup +    \expandafter{\markupstylesetup #1}% +  \def#1% +} + +% Markup style setup for left and right quotes. +\defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuplq{% +  \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp +    \csname markupsetuplq\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname +  \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuplqdefault \else \temp \fi +} + +\defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuprq{% +  \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp +    \csname markupsetuprq\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname +  \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuprqdefault \else \temp \fi +} + +{ +\catcode`\'=\active +\catcode`\`=\active + +\gdef\markupsetuplqdefault{\let`\lq} +\gdef\markupsetuprqdefault{\let'\rq} + +\gdef\markupsetcodequoteleft{\let`\codequoteleft} +\gdef\markupsetcodequoteright{\let'\codequoteright} +} + +\let\markupsetuplqcode \markupsetcodequoteleft +\let\markupsetuprqcode \markupsetcodequoteright +% +\let\markupsetuplqexample \markupsetcodequoteleft +\let\markupsetuprqexample \markupsetcodequoteright +% +\let\markupsetuplqkbd     \markupsetcodequoteleft +\let\markupsetuprqkbd     \markupsetcodequoteright +% +\let\markupsetuplqsamp \markupsetcodequoteleft +\let\markupsetuprqsamp \markupsetcodequoteright +% +\let\markupsetuplqverb \markupsetcodequoteleft +\let\markupsetuprqverb \markupsetcodequoteright +% +\let\markupsetuplqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteleft +\let\markupsetuprqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteright + +% Allow an option to not use regular directed right quote/apostrophe +% (char 0x27), but instead the undirected quote from cmtt (char 0x0d). +% The undirected quote is ugly, so don't make it the default, but it +% works for pasting with more pdf viewers (at least evince), the +% lilypond developers report.  xpdf does work with the regular 0x27. +% +\def\codequoteright{% +  \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax +    \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax +      '% +    \else \char'15 \fi +  \else \char'15 \fi +} +% +% and a similar option for the left quote char vs. a grave accent. +% Modern fonts display ASCII 0x60 as a grave accent, so some people like +% the code environments to do likewise. +% +\def\codequoteleft{% +  \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax +    \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax +      % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391 +      % \relax disables Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font. +      \relax`% +    \else \char'22 \fi +  \else \char'22 \fi +} + +% Commands to set the quote options. +% +\parseargdef\codequoteundirected{% +  \def\temp{#1}% +  \ifx\temp\onword +    \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname +      = t% +  \else\ifx\temp\offword +    \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname +      = \relax +  \else +    \errhelp = \EMsimple +    \errmessage{Unknown @codequoteundirected value `\temp', must be on|off}% +  \fi\fi +} +% +\parseargdef\codequotebacktick{% +  \def\temp{#1}% +  \ifx\temp\onword +    \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname +      = t% +  \else\ifx\temp\offword +    \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname +      = \relax +  \else +    \errhelp = \EMsimple +    \errmessage{Unknown @codequotebacktick value `\temp', must be on|off}% +  \fi\fi +} + +% [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391, disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font. +\def\noligaturesquoteleft{\relax\lq} + +% Count depth in font-changes, for error checks +\newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=0 + +% Font commands. + +% #1 is the font command (\sl or \it), #2 is the text to slant. +% If we are in a monospaced environment, however, 1) always use \ttsl, +% and 2) do not add an italic correction. +\def\dosmartslant#1#2{% +  \ifusingtt +    {{\ttsl #2}\let\next=\relax}% +    {\def\next{{#1#2}\futurelet\next\smartitaliccorrection}}% +  \next +} +\def\smartslanted{\dosmartslant\sl} +\def\smartitalic{\dosmartslant\it} + +% Output an italic correction unless \next (presumed to be the following +% character) is such as not to need one. +\def\smartitaliccorrection{% +  \ifx\next,% +  \else\ifx\next-% +  \else\ifx\next.% +  \else\ptexslash +  \fi\fi\fi +  \aftersmartic +} + +% Unconditional use \ttsl, and no ic.  @var is set to this for defuns. +\def\ttslanted#1{{\ttsl #1}} + +% @cite is like \smartslanted except unconditionally use \sl.  We never want +% ttsl for book titles, do we? +\def\cite#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitaliccorrection} + +\def\aftersmartic{} +\def\var#1{% +  \let\saveaftersmartic = \aftersmartic +  \def\aftersmartic{\null\let\aftersmartic=\saveaftersmartic}% +  \smartslanted{#1}% +} + +\let\i=\smartitalic +\let\slanted=\smartslanted +\let\dfn=\smartslanted +\let\emph=\smartitalic + +% Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii. +\def\r#1{{\rm #1}}              % roman font +\def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}}       % smallcaps font +\def\ii#1{{\it #1}}             % italic font + +% @b, explicit bold.  Also @strong. +\def\b#1{{\bf #1}} +\let\strong=\b + +% @sansserif, explicit sans. +\def\sansserif#1{{\sf #1}} + +% We can't just use \exhyphenpenalty, because that only has effect at +% the end of a paragraph.  Restore normal hyphenation at the end of the +% group within which \nohyphenation is presumably called. +% +\def\nohyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = -1  \aftergroup\restorehyphenation} +\def\restorehyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = `- } + +% Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value. +% Can't use plain's \frenchspacing because it uses the `\x notation, and +% sometimes \x has an active definition that messes things up. +% +\catcode`@=11 +  \def\plainfrenchspacing{% +    \sfcode\dotChar  =\@m \sfcode\questChar=\@m \sfcode\exclamChar=\@m +    \sfcode\colonChar=\@m \sfcode\semiChar =\@m \sfcode\commaChar =\@m +    \def\endofsentencespacefactor{1000}% for @. and friends +  } +  \def\plainnonfrenchspacing{% +    \sfcode`\.3000\sfcode`\?3000\sfcode`\!3000 +    \sfcode`\:2000\sfcode`\;1500\sfcode`\,1250 +    \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% for @. and friends +  } +\catcode`@=\other +\def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% default + +% @t, explicit typewriter. +\def\t#1{% +  {\tt \rawbackslash \plainfrenchspacing #1}% +  \null +} + +% @samp. +\def\samp#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{samp}\lq\tclose{#1}\rq\null}} + +% @indicateurl is \samp, that is, with quotes. +\let\indicateurl=\samp + +% @code (and similar) prints in typewriter, but with spaces the same +% size as normal in the surrounding text, without hyphenation, etc. +% This is a subroutine for that. +\def\tclose#1{% +  {% +    % Change normal interword space to be same as for the current font. +    \spaceskip = \fontdimen2\font +    % +    % Switch to typewriter. +    \tt +    % +    % But `\ ' produces the large typewriter interword space. +    \def\ {{\spaceskip = 0pt{} }}% +    % +    % Turn off hyphenation. +    \nohyphenation +    % +    \rawbackslash +    \plainfrenchspacing +    #1% +  }% +  \null % reset spacefactor to 1000 +} + +% We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in @code. +% Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes +% in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc. +% +% Unfortunately, TeX uses one parameter (\hyphenchar) to control +% both hyphenation at - and hyphenation within words. +% We must therefore turn them both off (\tclose does that) +% and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash. +%  -- rms. +{ +  \catcode`\-=\active \catcode`\_=\active +  \catcode`\'=\active \catcode`\`=\active +  \global\let'=\rq \global\let`=\lq  % default definitions +  % +  \global\def\code{\begingroup +    \setupmarkupstyle{code}% +    % The following should really be moved into \setupmarkupstyle handlers. +    \catcode\dashChar=\active  \catcode\underChar=\active +    \ifallowcodebreaks +     \let-\codedash +     \let_\codeunder +    \else +     \let-\normaldash +     \let_\realunder +    \fi +    \codex +  } +} + +\def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup} + +\def\normaldash{-} +\def\codedash{-\discretionary{}{}{}} +\def\codeunder{% +  % this is all so @math{@code{var_name}+1} can work.  In math mode, _ +  % is "active" (mathcode"8000) and \normalunderscore (or \char95, etc.) +  % will therefore expand the active definition of _, which is us +  % (inside @code that is), therefore an endless loop. +  \ifusingtt{\ifmmode +               \mathchar"075F % class 0=ordinary, family 7=ttfam, pos 0x5F=_. +             \else\normalunderscore \fi +             \discretionary{}{}{}}% +            {\_}% +} + +% An additional complication: the above will allow breaks after, e.g., +% each of the four underscores in __typeof__.  This is bad. +% @allowcodebreaks provides a document-level way to turn breaking at - +% and _ on and off. +% +\newif\ifallowcodebreaks  \allowcodebreakstrue + +\def\keywordtrue{true} +\def\keywordfalse{false} + +\parseargdef\allowcodebreaks{% +  \def\txiarg{#1}% +  \ifx\txiarg\keywordtrue +    \allowcodebreakstrue +  \else\ifx\txiarg\keywordfalse +    \allowcodebreaksfalse +  \else +    \errhelp = \EMsimple +    \errmessage{Unknown @allowcodebreaks option `\txiarg', must be true|false}% +  \fi\fi +} + +% For @command, @env, @file, @option quotes seem unnecessary, +% so use \code rather than \samp. +\let\command=\code +\let\env=\code +\let\file=\code +\let\option=\code + +% @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') takes an optional (comma-separated) +% second argument specifying the text to display and an optional third +% arg as text to display instead of (rather than in addition to) the url +% itself.  First (mandatory) arg is the url. +% (This \urefnobreak definition isn't used now, leaving it for a while +% for comparison.) +\def\urefnobreak#1{\dourefnobreak #1,,,\finish} +\def\dourefnobreak#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{\begingroup +  \unsepspaces +  \pdfurl{#1}% +  \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}% +  \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt +    \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that +  \else +    \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% +    \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt +      \ifpdf +        \unhbox0             % PDF: 2nd arg given, show only it +      \else +        \unhbox0\ (\code{#1})% DVI: 2nd arg given, show both it and url +      \fi +    \else +      \code{#1}% only url given, so show it +    \fi +  \fi +  \endlink +\endgroup} + +% This \urefbreak definition is the active one. +\def\urefbreak{\begingroup \urefcatcodes \dourefbreak} +\let\uref=\urefbreak +\def\dourefbreak#1{\urefbreakfinish #1,,,\finish} +\def\urefbreakfinish#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{% doesn't work in @example +  \unsepspaces +  \pdfurl{#1}% +  \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}% +  \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt +    \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that +  \else +    \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% +    \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt +      \ifpdf +        \unhbox0             % PDF: 2nd arg given, show only it +      \else +        \unhbox0\ (\urefcode{#1})% DVI: 2nd arg given, show both it and url +      \fi +    \else +      \urefcode{#1}% only url given, so show it +    \fi +  \fi +  \endlink +\endgroup} + +% Allow line breaks around only a few characters (only). +\def\urefcatcodes{% +  \catcode\ampChar=\active   \catcode\dotChar=\active +  \catcode\hashChar=\active  \catcode\questChar=\active +  \catcode\slashChar=\active +} +{ +  \urefcatcodes +  % +  \global\def\urefcode{\begingroup +    \setupmarkupstyle{code}% +    \urefcatcodes +    \let&\urefcodeamp +    \let.\urefcodedot +    \let#\urefcodehash +    \let?\urefcodequest +    \let/\urefcodeslash +    \codex +  } +  % +  % By default, they are just regular characters. +  \global\def&{\normalamp} +  \global\def.{\normaldot} +  \global\def#{\normalhash} +  \global\def?{\normalquest} +  \global\def/{\normalslash} +} + +% we put a little stretch before and after the breakable chars, to help +% line breaking of long url's.  The unequal skips make look better in +% cmtt at least, especially for dots. +\def\urefprestretch{\urefprebreak \hskip0pt plus.13em } +\def\urefpoststretch{\urefpostbreak \hskip0pt plus.1em } +% +\def\urefcodeamp{\urefprestretch \&\urefpoststretch} +\def\urefcodedot{\urefprestretch .\urefpoststretch} +\def\urefcodehash{\urefprestretch \#\urefpoststretch} +\def\urefcodequest{\urefprestretch ?\urefpoststretch} +\def\urefcodeslash{\futurelet\next\urefcodeslashfinish} +{ +  \catcode`\/=\active +  \global\def\urefcodeslashfinish{% +    \urefprestretch \slashChar +    % Allow line break only after the final / in a sequence of +    % slashes, to avoid line break between the slashes in http://. +    \ifx\next/\else \urefpoststretch \fi +  } +} + +% One more complication: by default we'll break after the special +% characters, but some people like to break before the special chars, so +% allow that.  Also allow no breaking at all, for manual control. +% +\parseargdef\urefbreakstyle{% +  \def\txiarg{#1}% +  \ifx\txiarg\wordnone +    \def\urefprebreak{\nobreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\nobreak} +  \else\ifx\txiarg\wordbefore +    \def\urefprebreak{\allowbreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\nobreak} +  \else\ifx\txiarg\wordafter +    \def\urefprebreak{\nobreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\allowbreak} +  \else +    \errhelp = \EMsimple +    \errmessage{Unknown @urefbreakstyle setting `\txiarg'}% +  \fi\fi\fi +} +\def\wordafter{after} +\def\wordbefore{before} +\def\wordnone{none} + +\urefbreakstyle after + +% @url synonym for @uref, since that's how everyone uses it. +% +\let\url=\uref + +% rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97. +% So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf. +% +%\def\email#1{\angleleft{\tt #1}\angleright} +\ifpdf +  \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,\finish} +  \def\doemail#1,#2,#3\finish{\begingroup +    \unsepspaces +    \pdfurl{mailto:#1}% +    \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% +    \ifdim\wd0>0pt\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi +    \endlink +  \endgroup} +\else +  \let\email=\uref +\fi + +% @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always), +%   `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends), +%   or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always). +\parseargdef\kbdinputstyle{% +  \def\txiarg{#1}% +  \ifx\txiarg\worddistinct +    \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}% +  \else\ifx\txiarg\wordexample +    \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}% +  \else\ifx\txiarg\wordcode +    \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}% +  \else +    \errhelp = \EMsimple +    \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle setting `\txiarg'}% +  \fi\fi\fi +} +\def\worddistinct{distinct} +\def\wordexample{example} +\def\wordcode{code} + +% Default is `distinct'. +\kbdinputstyle distinct + +% @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command, +% then @kbd has no effect. +\def\kbd#1{{\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdsub\look??\par}} + +\def\xkey{\key} +\def\kbdsub#1#2#3\par{% +  \def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??}% +  \ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}% +  \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd}\look}}\fi +  \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd}\look}}\fi +} + +% definition of @key that produces a lozenge.  Doesn't adjust to text size. +%\setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1} +%\font\keysy=cmsy9 +%\def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{% +%  \raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{% +%    \vbox{\hrule\kern-0.4pt +%     \hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}% +%    \kern-0.4pt\hrule}% +%  \kern-.06em\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleright}}}} + +% definition of @key with no lozenge.  If the current font is already +% monospace, don't change it; that way, we respect @kbdinputstyle.  But +% if it isn't monospace, then use \tt. +% +\def\key#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{key}% +  \nohyphenation +  \ifmonospace\else\tt\fi +  #1}\null} + +% @clicksequence{File @click{} Open ...} +\def\clicksequence#1{\begingroup #1\endgroup} + +% @clickstyle @arrow   (by default) +\parseargdef\clickstyle{\def\click{#1}} +\def\click{\arrow} + +% Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'.  The only reason for the +% argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of @dmn{}pt. +% +\def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1} + +% @l was never documented to mean ``switch to the Lisp font'', +% and it is not used as such in any manual I can find.  We need it for +% Polish suppressed-l.  --karl, 22sep96. +%\def\l#1{{\li #1}\null} + +% @acronym for "FBI", "NATO", and the like. +% We print this one point size smaller, since it's intended for +% all-uppercase. +% +\def\acronym#1{\doacronym #1,,\finish} +\def\doacronym#1,#2,#3\finish{% +  {\selectfonts\lsize #1}% +  \def\temp{#2}% +  \ifx\temp\empty \else +    \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})% +  \fi +  \null % reset \spacefactor=1000 +} + +% @abbr for "Comput. J." and the like. +% No font change, but don't do end-of-sentence spacing. +% +\def\abbr#1{\doabbr #1,,\finish} +\def\doabbr#1,#2,#3\finish{% +  {\plainfrenchspacing #1}% +  \def\temp{#2}% +  \ifx\temp\empty \else +    \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})% +  \fi +  \null % reset \spacefactor=1000 +} + +% @asis just yields its argument.  Used with @table, for example. +% +\def\asis#1{#1} + +% @math outputs its argument in math mode. +% +% One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean +% an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}.  So make +% _ active, and distinguish by seeing if the current family is \slfam, +% which is what @var uses. +{ +  \catcode`\_ = \active +  \gdef\mathunderscore{% +    \catcode`\_=\active +    \def_{\ifnum\fam=\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}% +  } +} +% Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a math (or tt) \. +% FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (for no +% particular reason), but this is not advertised and we don't care. +% +% The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\. +\def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=\ttfam \mathchar"075C \else\backslash \fi} +% +\def\math{% +  \tex +  \mathunderscore +  \let\\ = \mathbackslash +  \mathactive +  % make the texinfo accent commands work in math mode +  \let\"=\ddot +  \let\'=\acute +  \let\==\bar +  \let\^=\hat +  \let\`=\grave +  \let\u=\breve +  \let\v=\check +  \let\~=\tilde +  \let\dotaccent=\dot +  $\finishmath +} +\def\finishmath#1{#1$\endgroup}  % Close the group opened by \tex. + +% Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math. +% We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an argument +% to a command which sets the catcodes (such as @item or @section). +% +{ +  \catcode`^ = \active +  \catcode`< = \active +  \catcode`> = \active +  \catcode`+ = \active +  \catcode`' = \active +  \gdef\mathactive{% +    \let^ = \ptexhat +    \let< = \ptexless +    \let> = \ptexgtr +    \let+ = \ptexplus +    \let' = \ptexquoteright +  } +} + +% ctrl is no longer a Texinfo command, but leave this definition for fun. +\def\ctrl #1{{\tt \rawbackslash \hat}#1} + +% @inlinefmt{FMTNAME,PROCESSED-TEXT} and @inlineraw{FMTNAME,RAW-TEXT}. +% Ignore unless FMTNAME == tex; then it is like @iftex and @tex, +% except specified as a normal braced arg, so no newlines to worry about. +% +\def\outfmtnametex{tex} +% +\long\def\inlinefmt#1{\doinlinefmt #1,\finish} +\long\def\doinlinefmt#1,#2,\finish{% +  \def\inlinefmtname{#1}% +  \ifx\inlinefmtname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\fi +} +% For raw, must switch into @tex before parsing the argument, to avoid +% setting catcodes prematurely.  Doing it this way means that, for +% example, @inlineraw{html, foo{bar} gets a parse error instead of being +% ignored.  But this isn't important because if people want a literal +% *right* brace they would have to use a command anyway, so they may as +% well use a command to get a left brace too.  We could re-use the +% delimiter character idea from \verb, but it seems like overkill. +% +\long\def\inlineraw{\tex \doinlineraw} +\long\def\doinlineraw#1{\doinlinerawtwo #1,\finish} +\def\doinlinerawtwo#1,#2,\finish{% +  \def\inlinerawname{#1}% +  \ifx\inlinerawname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\fi +  \endgroup % close group opened by \tex. +} + + +\message{glyphs,} +% and logos. + +% @@ prints an @, as does @atchar{}. +\def\@{\char64 } +\let\atchar=\@ + +% @{ @} @lbracechar{} @rbracechar{} all generate brace characters. +% Unless we're in typewriter, use \ecfont because the CM text fonts do +% not have braces, and we don't want to switch into math. +\def\mylbrace{{\ifmonospace\else\ecfont\fi \char123}} +\def\myrbrace{{\ifmonospace\else\ecfont\fi \char125}} +\let\{=\mylbrace \let\lbracechar=\{ +\let\}=\myrbrace \let\rbracechar=\} +\begingroup +  % Definitions to produce \{ and \} commands for indices, +  % and @{ and @} for the aux/toc files. +  \catcode`\{ = \other \catcode`\} = \other +  \catcode`\[ = 1 \catcode`\] = 2 +  \catcode`\! = 0 \catcode`\\ = \other +  !gdef!lbracecmd[\{]% +  !gdef!rbracecmd[\}]% +  !gdef!lbraceatcmd[@{]% +  !gdef!rbraceatcmd[@}]% +!endgroup + +% @comma{} to avoid , parsing problems. +\let\comma = , + +% Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent +% Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H. +\let\, = \ptexc +\let\dotaccent = \ptexdot +\def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}} +\let\tieaccent = \ptext +\let\ubaraccent = \ptexb +\let\udotaccent = \d + +% Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown @ordf @ordm +% Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss. +\def\questiondown{?`} +\def\exclamdown{!`} +\def\ordf{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{a}}} +\def\ordm{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{o}}} + +% Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents. +\def\imacro{i} +\def\jmacro{j} +\def\dotless#1{% +  \def\temp{#1}% +  \ifx\temp\imacro \ifmmode\imath \else\ptexi \fi +  \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \ifmmode\jmath \else\j \fi +  \else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j}% +  \fi\fi +} + +% The \TeX{} logo, as in plain, but resetting the spacing so that a +% period following counts as ending a sentence.  (Idea found in latex.) +% +\edef\TeX{\TeX \spacefactor=1000 } + +% @LaTeX{} logo.  Not quite the same results as the definition in +% latex.ltx, since we use a different font for the raised A; it's most +% convenient for us to use an explicitly smaller font, rather than using +% the \scriptstyle font (since we don't reset \scriptstyle and +% \scriptscriptstyle). +% +\def\LaTeX{% +  L\kern-.36em +  {\setbox0=\hbox{T}% +   \vbox to \ht0{\hbox{% +     \ifx\textnominalsize\xwordpt +       % for 10pt running text, \lllsize (8pt) is too small for the A in LaTeX. +       % Revert to plain's \scriptsize, which is 7pt. +       \count255=\the\fam $\fam\count255 \scriptstyle A$% +     \else +       % For 11pt, we can use our lllsize. +       \selectfonts\lllsize A% +     \fi +     }% +     \vss +  }}% +  \kern-.15em +  \TeX +} + +% Some math mode symbols. +\def\bullet{$\ptexbullet$} +\def\geq{\ifmmode \ge\else $\ge$\fi} +\def\leq{\ifmmode \le\else $\le$\fi} +\def\minus{\ifmmode -\else $-$\fi} + +% @dots{} outputs an ellipsis using the current font. +% We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in the cm +% typewriter fonts as three actual period characters; on the other hand, +% in other typewriter fonts three periods are wider than 1.5em.  So do +% whichever is larger. +% +\def\dots{% +  \leavevmode +  \setbox0=\hbox{...}% get width of three periods +  \ifdim\wd0 > 1.5em +    \dimen0 = \wd0 +  \else +    \dimen0 = 1.5em +  \fi +  \hbox to \dimen0{% +    \hskip 0pt plus.25fil +    .\hskip 0pt plus1fil +    .\hskip 0pt plus1fil +    .\hskip 0pt plus.5fil +  }% +} + +% @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis. +% +\def\enddots{% +  \dots +  \spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor +} + +% @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}. +% +% Since these characters are used in examples, they should be an even number of +% \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em. +% +\def\point{$\star$} +\def\arrow{\leavevmode\raise.05ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\rightarrow$\hfil}} +\def\result{\leavevmode\raise.05ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}} +\def\expansion{\leavevmode\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}} +\def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil}} +\def\equiv{\leavevmode\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}} + +% The @error{} command. +% Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit. +% +\newbox\errorbox +% +{\tentt \global\dimen0 = 3em}% Width of the box. +\dimen2 = .55pt % Thickness of rules +% The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.) +\setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \reducedsf \putworderror\kern-1.5pt} +% +\setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil +   \hsize = \dimen0 \advance\hsize by -5.8pt % Space to left+right. +   \advance\hsize by -2\dimen2 % Rules. +   \vbox{% +      \hrule height\dimen2 +      \hbox{\vrule width\dimen2 \kern3pt          % Space to left of text. +         \vtop{\kern2.4pt \box0 \kern2.4pt}% Space above/below. +         \kern3pt\vrule width\dimen2}% Space to right. +      \hrule height\dimen2} +    \hfil} +% +\def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex\copy\errorbox} + +% @pounds{} is a sterling sign, which Knuth put in the CM italic font. +% +\def\pounds{{\it\$}} + +% @euro{} comes from a separate font, depending on the current style. +% We use the free feym* fonts from the eurosym package by Henrik +% Theiling, which support regular, slanted, bold and bold slanted (and +% "outlined" (blackboard board, sort of) versions, which we don't need). +% It is available from http://www.ctan.org/tex-archive/fonts/eurosym. +% +% Although only regular is the truly official Euro symbol, we ignore +% that.  The Euro is designed to be slightly taller than the regular +% font height. +% +% feymr - regular +% feymo - slanted +% feybr - bold +% feybo - bold slanted +% +% There is no good (free) typewriter version, to my knowledge. +% A feymr10 euro is ~7.3pt wide, while a normal cmtt10 char is ~5.25pt wide. +% Hmm. +% +% Also doesn't work in math.  Do we need to do math with euro symbols? +% Hope not. +% +% +\def\euro{{\eurofont e}} +\def\eurofont{% +  % We set the font at each command, rather than predefining it in +  % \textfonts and the other font-switching commands, so that +  % installations which never need the symbol don't have to have the +  % font installed. +  % +  % There is only one designed size (nominal 10pt), so we always scale +  % that to the current nominal size. +  % +  % By the way, simply using "at 1em" works for cmr10 and the like, but +  % does not work for cmbx10 and other extended/shrunken fonts. +  % +  \def\eurosize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}% +  % +  \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename +    % bold: +    \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feybo10}{feybr10} at \eurosize +  \else +    % regular: +    \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feymo10}{feymr10} at \eurosize +  \fi +  \thiseurofont +} + +% Glyphs from the EC fonts.  We don't use \let for the aliases, because +% sometimes we redefine the original macro, and the alias should reflect +% the redefinition. +% +% Use LaTeX names for the Icelandic letters. +\def\DH{{\ecfont \char"D0}} % Eth +\def\dh{{\ecfont \char"F0}} % eth +\def\TH{{\ecfont \char"DE}} % Thorn +\def\th{{\ecfont \char"FE}} % thorn +% +\def\guillemetleft{{\ecfont \char"13}} +\def\guillemotleft{\guillemetleft} +\def\guillemetright{{\ecfont \char"14}} +\def\guillemotright{\guillemetright} +\def\guilsinglleft{{\ecfont \char"0E}} +\def\guilsinglright{{\ecfont \char"0F}} +\def\quotedblbase{{\ecfont \char"12}} +\def\quotesinglbase{{\ecfont \char"0D}} +% +% This positioning is not perfect (see the ogonek LaTeX package), but +% we have the precomposed glyphs for the most common cases.  We put the +% tests to use those glyphs in the single \ogonek macro so we have fewer +% dummy definitions to worry about for index entries, etc. +% +% ogonek is also used with other letters in Lithuanian (IOU), but using +% the precomposed glyphs for those is not so easy since they aren't in +% the same EC font. +\def\ogonek#1{{% +  \def\temp{#1}% +  \ifx\temp\macrocharA\Aogonek +  \else\ifx\temp\macrochara\aogonek +  \else\ifx\temp\macrocharE\Eogonek +  \else\ifx\temp\macrochare\eogonek +  \else +    \ecfont \setbox0=\hbox{#1}% +    \ifdim\ht0=1ex\accent"0C #1% +    \else\ooalign{\unhbox0\crcr\hidewidth\char"0C \hidewidth}% +    \fi +  \fi\fi\fi\fi +  }% +} +\def\Aogonek{{\ecfont \char"81}}\def\macrocharA{A} +\def\aogonek{{\ecfont \char"A1}}\def\macrochara{a} +\def\Eogonek{{\ecfont \char"86}}\def\macrocharE{E} +\def\eogonek{{\ecfont \char"A6}}\def\macrochare{e} +% +% Use the ec* fonts (cm-super in outline format) for non-CM glyphs. +\def\ecfont{% +  % We can't distinguish serif/sans and italic/slanted, but this +  % is used for crude hacks anyway (like adding French and German +  % quotes to documents typeset with CM, where we lose kerning), so +  % hopefully nobody will notice/care. +  \edef\ecsize{\csname\curfontsize ecsize\endcsname}% +  \edef\nominalsize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}% +  \ifmonospace +    % typewriter: +    \font\thisecfont = ectt\ecsize \space at \nominalsize +  \else +    \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename +      % bold: +      \font\thisecfont = ecb\ifusingit{i}{x}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize +    \else +      % regular: +      \font\thisecfont = ec\ifusingit{ti}{rm}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize +    \fi +  \fi +  \thisecfont +} + +% @registeredsymbol - R in a circle.  The font for the R should really +% be smaller yet, but lllsize is the best we can do for now. +% Adapted from the plain.tex definition of \copyright. +% +\def\registeredsymbol{% +  $^{{\ooalign{\hfil\raise.07ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize R}% +               \hfil\crcr\Orb}}% +    }$% +} + +% @textdegree - the normal degrees sign. +% +\def\textdegree{$^\circ$} + +% Laurent Siebenmann reports \Orb undefined with: +%  Textures 1.7.7 (preloaded format=plain 93.10.14)  (68K)  16 APR 2004 02:38 +% so we'll define it if necessary. +% +\ifx\Orb\thisisundefined +\def\Orb{\mathhexbox20D} +\fi + +% Quotes. +\chardef\quotedblleft="5C +\chardef\quotedblright=`\" +\chardef\quoteleft=`\` +\chardef\quoteright=`\' + + +\message{page headings,} + +\newskip\titlepagetopglue \titlepagetopglue = 1.5in +\newskip\titlepagebottomglue \titlepagebottomglue = 2pc + +% First the title page.  Must do @settitle before @titlepage. +\newif\ifseenauthor +\newif\iffinishedtitlepage + +% Do an implicit @contents or @shortcontents after @end titlepage if the +% user says @setcontentsaftertitlepage or @setshortcontentsaftertitlepage. +% +\newif\ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage + \let\setcontentsaftertitlepage = \setcontentsaftertitlepagetrue +\newif\ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage + \let\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage = \setshortcontentsaftertitlepagetrue + +\parseargdef\shorttitlepage{% +  \begingroup \hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}% +  \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page} + +\envdef\titlepage{% +  % Open one extra group, as we want to close it in the middle of \Etitlepage. +  \begingroup +    \parindent=0pt \textfonts +    % Leave some space at the very top of the page. +    \vglue\titlepagetopglue +    % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title. +    \finishedtitlepagetrue +    % +    % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space +    % at the top of the second.  We don't want the ragged left on the second. +    \let\oldpage = \page +    \def\page{% +      \iffinishedtitlepage\else +	 \finishtitlepage +      \fi +      \let\page = \oldpage +      \page +      \null +    }% +} + +\def\Etitlepage{% +    \iffinishedtitlepage\else +	\finishtitlepage +    \fi +    % It is important to do the page break before ending the group, +    % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group. +    % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page +    % after the title page, which we certainly don't want. +    \oldpage +  \endgroup +  % +  % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are +  % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers. +  \HEADINGSon +  % +  % If they want short, they certainly want long too. +  \ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage +    \shortcontents +    \contents +    \global\let\shortcontents = \relax +    \global\let\contents = \relax +  \fi +  % +  \ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage +    \contents +    \global\let\contents = \relax +    \global\let\shortcontents = \relax +  \fi +} + +\def\finishtitlepage{% +  \vskip4pt \hrule height 2pt width \hsize +  \vskip\titlepagebottomglue +  \finishedtitlepagetrue +} + +% Settings used for typesetting titles: no hyphenation, no indentation, +% don't worry much about spacing, ragged right.  This should be used +% inside a \vbox, and fonts need to be set appropriately first.  Because +% it is always used for titles, nothing else, we call \rmisbold.  \par +% should be specified before the end of the \vbox, since a vbox is a group. +% +\def\raggedtitlesettings{% +  \rmisbold +  \hyphenpenalty=10000 +  \parindent=0pt +  \tolerance=5000 +  \ptexraggedright +} + +% Macros to be used within @titlepage: + +\let\subtitlerm=\tenrm +\def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines} + +\parseargdef\title{% +  \checkenv\titlepage +  \vbox{\titlefonts \raggedtitlesettings #1\par}% +  % print a rule at the page bottom also. +  \finishedtitlepagefalse +  \vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt +} + +\parseargdef\subtitle{% +  \checkenv\titlepage +  {\subtitlefont \rightline{#1}}% +} + +% @author should come last, but may come many times. +% It can also be used inside @quotation. +% +\parseargdef\author{% +  \def\temp{\quotation}% +  \ifx\thisenv\temp +    \def\quotationauthor{#1}% printed in \Equotation. +  \else +    \checkenv\titlepage +    \ifseenauthor\else \vskip 0pt plus 1filll \seenauthortrue \fi +    {\secfonts\rmisbold \leftline{#1}}% +  \fi +} + + +% Set up page headings and footings. + +\let\thispage=\folio + +\newtoks\evenheadline    % headline on even pages +\newtoks\oddheadline     % headline on odd pages +\newtoks\evenfootline    % footline on even pages +\newtoks\oddfootline     % footline on odd pages + +% Now make TeX use those variables +\headline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline +                            \else \the\evenheadline \fi}} +\footline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline +                            \else \the\evenfootline \fi}\HEADINGShook} +\let\HEADINGShook=\relax + +% Commands to set those variables. +% For example, this is what  @headings on  does +% @evenheading @thistitle|@thispage|@thischapter +% @oddheading @thischapter|@thispage|@thistitle +% @evenfooting @thisfile|| +% @oddfooting ||@thisfile + + +\def\evenheading{\parsearg\evenheadingxxx} +\def\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish} +\def\evenheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{% +\global\evenheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}} + +\def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx} +\def\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish} +\def\oddheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{% +\global\oddheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}} + +\parseargdef\everyheading{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}% + +\def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx} +\def\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish} +\def\evenfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{% +\global\evenfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}} + +\def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx} +\def\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish} +\def\oddfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{% +  \global\oddfootline = {\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}% +  % +  % Leave some space for the footline.  Hopefully ok to assume +  % @evenfooting will not be used by itself. +  \global\advance\pageheight by -12pt +  \global\advance\vsize by -12pt +} + +\parseargdef\everyfooting{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}} + +% @evenheadingmarks top     \thischapter <- chapter at the top of a page +% @evenheadingmarks bottom  \thischapter <- chapter at the bottom of a page +% +% The same set of arguments for: +% +% @oddheadingmarks +% @evenfootingmarks +% @oddfootingmarks +% @everyheadingmarks +% @everyfootingmarks + +\def\evenheadingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{heading}} +\def\oddheadingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{heading}} +\def\evenfootingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{footing}} +\def\oddfootingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{footing}} +\def\everyheadingmarks#1 {\headingmarks{even}{heading}{#1} +                          \headingmarks{odd}{heading}{#1} } +\def\everyfootingmarks#1 {\headingmarks{even}{footing}{#1} +                          \headingmarks{odd}{footing}{#1} } +% #1 = even/odd, #2 = heading/footing, #3 = top/bottom. +\def\headingmarks#1#2#3 {% +  \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp \csname get#3headingmarks\endcsname +  \global\expandafter\let\csname get#1#2marks\endcsname \temp +} + +\everyheadingmarks bottom +\everyfootingmarks bottom + +% @headings double      turns headings on for double-sided printing. +% @headings single      turns headings on for single-sided printing. +% @headings off         turns them off. +% @headings on          same as @headings double, retained for compatibility. +% @headings after       turns on double-sided headings after this page. +% @headings doubleafter turns on double-sided headings after this page. +% @headings singleafter turns on single-sided headings after this page. +% By default, they are off at the start of a document, +% and turned `on' after @end titlepage. + +\def\headings #1 {\csname HEADINGS#1\endcsname} + +\def\headingsoff{% non-global headings elimination +  \evenheadline={\hfil}\evenfootline={\hfil}% +   \oddheadline={\hfil}\oddfootline={\hfil}% +} + +\def\HEADINGSoff{{\globaldefs=1 \headingsoff}} % global setting +\HEADINGSoff  % it's the default + +% When we turn headings on, set the page number to 1. +% For double-sided printing, put current file name in lower left corner, +% chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document +% title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top +% edge of all pages. +\def\HEADINGSdouble{% +\global\pageno=1 +\global\evenfootline={\hfil} +\global\oddfootline={\hfil} +\global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}} +\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} +\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage +} +\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager + +% For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page, +% page number on top right. +\def\HEADINGSsingle{% +\global\pageno=1 +\global\evenfootline={\hfil} +\global\oddfootline={\hfil} +\global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} +\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} +\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager +} +\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble} + +\def\HEADINGSafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSdoublex} +\let\HEADINGSdoubleafter=\HEADINGSafter +\def\HEADINGSdoublex{% +\global\evenfootline={\hfil} +\global\oddfootline={\hfil} +\global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}} +\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} +\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage +} + +\def\HEADINGSsingleafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSsinglex} +\def\HEADINGSsinglex{% +\global\evenfootline={\hfil} +\global\oddfootline={\hfil} +\global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} +\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} +\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager +} + +% Subroutines used in generating headings +% This produces Day Month Year style of output. +% Only define if not already defined, in case a txi-??.tex file has set +% up a different format (e.g., txi-cs.tex does this). +\ifx\today\thisisundefined +\def\today{% +  \number\day\space +  \ifcase\month +  \or\putwordMJan\or\putwordMFeb\or\putwordMMar\or\putwordMApr +  \or\putwordMMay\or\putwordMJun\or\putwordMJul\or\putwordMAug +  \or\putwordMSep\or\putwordMOct\or\putwordMNov\or\putwordMDec +  \fi +  \space\number\year} +\fi + +% @settitle line...  specifies the title of the document, for headings. +% It generates no output of its own. +\def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle} +\def\settitle{\parsearg{\gdef\thistitle}} + + +\message{tables,} +% Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x). + +% default indentation of table text +\newdimen\tableindent \tableindent=.8in +% default indentation of @itemize and @enumerate text +\newdimen\itemindent  \itemindent=.3in +% margin between end of table item and start of table text. +\newdimen\itemmargin  \itemmargin=.1in + +% used internally for \itemindent minus \itemmargin +\newdimen\itemmax + +% Note @table, @ftable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with +% these defs. +% They also define \itemindex +% to index the item name in whatever manner is desired (perhaps none). + +\newif\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip + +\def\itemxpar{\par\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip\nobreak\vskip-\parskip\nobreak\fi} + +\def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz} +\def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz} + +\def\itemzzz #1{\begingroup % +  \advance\hsize by -\rightskip +  \advance\hsize by -\tableindent +  \setbox0=\hbox{\itemindicate{#1}}% +  \itemindex{#1}% +  \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx. +  % +  % If the item text does not fit in the space we have, put it on a line +  % by itself, and do not allow a page break either before or after that +  % line.  We do not start a paragraph here because then if the next +  % command is, e.g., @kindex, the whatsit would get put into the +  % horizontal list on a line by itself, resulting in extra blank space. +  \ifdim \wd0>\itemmax +    % +    % Make this a paragraph so we get the \parskip glue and wrapping, +    % but leave it ragged-right. +    \begingroup +      \advance\leftskip by-\tableindent +      \advance\hsize by\tableindent +      \advance\rightskip by0pt plus1fil\relax +      \leavevmode\unhbox0\par +    \endgroup +    % +    % We're going to be starting a paragraph, but we don't want the +    % \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started. +    \nobreak \vskip-\parskip +    % +    % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up.  However, if +    % what follows is an environment such as @example, there will be no +    % \parskip glue; then the negative vskip we just inserted would +    % cause the example and the item to crash together.  So we use this +    % bizarre value of 10001 as a signal to \aboveenvbreak to insert +    % \parskip glue after all.  Section titles are handled this way also. +    % +    \penalty 10001 +    \endgroup +    \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse +  \else +    % The item text fits into the space.  Start a paragraph, so that the +    % following text (if any) will end up on the same line. +    \noindent +    % Do this with kerns and \unhbox so that if there is a footnote in +    % the item text, it can migrate to the main vertical list and +    % eventually be printed. +    \nobreak\kern-\tableindent +    \dimen0 = \itemmax  \advance\dimen0 by \itemmargin \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 +    \unhbox0 +    \nobreak\kern\dimen0 +    \endgroup +    \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue +  \fi +} + +\def\item{\errmessage{@item while not in a list environment}} +\def\itemx{\errmessage{@itemx while not in a list environment}} + +% @table, @ftable, @vtable. +\envdef\table{% +  \let\itemindex\gobble +  \tablecheck{table}% +} +\envdef\ftable{% +  \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {fn}{\code{##1}}}% +  \tablecheck{ftable}% +} +\envdef\vtable{% +  \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {vr}{\code{##1}}}% +  \tablecheck{vtable}% +} +\def\tablecheck#1{% +  \ifnum \the\catcode`\^^M=\active +    \endgroup +    \errmessage{This command won't work in this context; perhaps the problem is +      that we are \inenvironment\thisenv}% +    \def\next{\doignore{#1}}% +  \else +    \let\next\tablex +  \fi +  \next +} +\def\tablex#1{% +  \def\itemindicate{#1}% +  \parsearg\tabley +} +\def\tabley#1{% +  {% +    \makevalueexpandable +    \edef\temp{\noexpand\tablez #1\space\space\space}% +    \expandafter +  }\temp \endtablez +} +\def\tablez #1 #2 #3 #4\endtablez{% +  \aboveenvbreak +  \ifnum 0#1>0 \advance \leftskip by #1\mil \fi +  \ifnum 0#2>0 \tableindent=#2\mil \fi +  \ifnum 0#3>0 \advance \rightskip by #3\mil \fi +  \itemmax=\tableindent +  \advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin +  \advance \leftskip by \tableindent +  \exdentamount=\tableindent +  \parindent = 0pt +  \parskip = \smallskipamount +  \ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi +  \let\item = \internalBitem +  \let\itemx = \internalBitemx +} +\def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak} +\let\Eftable\Etable +\let\Evtable\Etable +\let\Eitemize\Etable +\let\Eenumerate\Etable + +% This is the counter used by @enumerate, which is really @itemize + +\newcount \itemno + +\envdef\itemize{\parsearg\doitemize} + +\def\doitemize#1{% +  \aboveenvbreak +  \itemmax=\itemindent +  \advance\itemmax by -\itemmargin +  \advance\leftskip by \itemindent +  \exdentamount=\itemindent +  \parindent=0pt +  \parskip=\smallskipamount +  \ifdim\parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi +  % +  % Try typesetting the item mark that if the document erroneously says +  % something like @itemize @samp (intending @table), there's an error +  % right away at the @itemize.  It's not the best error message in the +  % world, but it's better than leaving it to the @item.  This means if +  % the user wants an empty mark, they have to say @w{} not just @w. +  \def\itemcontents{#1}% +  \setbox0 = \hbox{\itemcontents}% +  % +  % @itemize with no arg is equivalent to @itemize @bullet. +  \ifx\itemcontents\empty\def\itemcontents{\bullet}\fi +  % +  \let\item=\itemizeitem +} + +% Definition of @item while inside @itemize and @enumerate. +% +\def\itemizeitem{% +  \advance\itemno by 1  % for enumerations +  {\let\par=\endgraf \smallbreak}% reasonable place to break +  {% +   % If the document has an @itemize directly after a section title, a +   % \nobreak will be last on the list, and \sectionheading will have +   % done a \vskip-\parskip.  In that case, we don't want to zero +   % parskip, or the item text will crash with the heading.  On the +   % other hand, when there is normal text preceding the item (as there +   % usually is), we do want to zero parskip, or there would be too much +   % space.  In that case, we won't have a \nobreak before.  At least +   % that's the theory. +   \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \parskip=0in \fi +   \noindent +   \hbox to 0pt{\hss \itemcontents \kern\itemmargin}% +   % +   \vadjust{\penalty 1200}}% not good to break after first line of item. +  \flushcr +} + +% \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in +% TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder. +% +\def\splitoff#1#2\endmark{\def\first{#1}\def\rest{#2}}% + +% Allow an optional argument of an uppercase letter, lowercase letter, +% or number, to specify the first label in the enumerated list.  No +% argument is the same as `1'. +% +\envparseargdef\enumerate{\enumeratey #1  \endenumeratey} +\def\enumeratey #1 #2\endenumeratey{% +  % If we were given no argument, pretend we were given `1'. +  \def\thearg{#1}% +  \ifx\thearg\empty \def\thearg{1}\fi +  % +  % Detect if the argument is a single token.  If so, it might be a +  % letter.  Otherwise, the only valid thing it can be is a number. +  % (We will always have one token, because of the test we just made. +  % This is a good thing, since \splitoff doesn't work given nothing at +  % all -- the first parameter is undelimited.) +  \expandafter\splitoff\thearg\endmark +  \ifx\rest\empty +    % Only one token in the argument.  It could still be anything. +    % A ``lowercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is nonzero. +    % An ``uppercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is both nonzero, and +    %   not equal to itself. +    % Otherwise, we assume it's a number. +    % +    % We need the \relax at the end of the \ifnum lines to stop TeX from +    % continuing to look for a <number>. +    % +    \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=0\relax +      \numericenumerate % a number (we hope) +    \else +      % It's a letter. +      \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=\expandafter`\thearg\relax +        \lowercaseenumerate % lowercase letter +      \else +        \uppercaseenumerate % uppercase letter +      \fi +    \fi +  \else +    % Multiple tokens in the argument.  We hope it's a number. +    \numericenumerate +  \fi +} + +% An @enumerate whose labels are integers.  The starting integer is +% given in \thearg. +% +\def\numericenumerate{% +  \itemno = \thearg +  \startenumeration{\the\itemno}% +} + +% The starting (lowercase) letter is in \thearg. +\def\lowercaseenumerate{% +  \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg +  \startenumeration{% +    % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet. +    \ifnum\itemno=0 +      \errmessage{No more lowercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger +                  alphabet}% +    \fi +    \char\lccode\itemno +  }% +} + +% The starting (uppercase) letter is in \thearg. +\def\uppercaseenumerate{% +  \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg +  \startenumeration{% +    % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet. +    \ifnum\itemno=0 +      \errmessage{No more uppercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger +                  alphabet} +    \fi +    \char\uccode\itemno +  }% +} + +% Call \doitemize, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the +% common last two arguments.  Also subtract one from the initial value in +% \itemno, since @item increments \itemno. +% +\def\startenumeration#1{% +  \advance\itemno by -1 +  \doitemize{#1.}\flushcr +} + +% @alphaenumerate and @capsenumerate are abbreviations for giving an arg +% to @enumerate. +% +\def\alphaenumerate{\enumerate{a}} +\def\capsenumerate{\enumerate{A}} +\def\Ealphaenumerate{\Eenumerate} +\def\Ecapsenumerate{\Eenumerate} + + +% @multitable macros +% Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94, 3/6/96 +% +% @multitable ... @end multitable will make as many columns as desired. +% Contents of each column will wrap at width given in preamble.  Width +% can be specified either with sample text given in a template line, +% or in percent of \hsize, the current width of text on page. + +% Table can continue over pages but will only break between lines. + +% To make preamble: +% +% Either define widths of columns in terms of percent of \hsize: +%   @multitable @columnfractions .25 .3 .45 +%   @item ... +% +%   Numbers following @columnfractions are the percent of the total +%   current hsize to be used for each column. You may use as many +%   columns as desired. + + +% Or use a template: +%   @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template} +%   @item ... +%   using the widest term desired in each column. + +% Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column +% starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's +% with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed, +% ie, @tab@tab@tab will produce two empty columns. + +% @item, @tab do not need to be on their own lines, but it will not hurt +% if they are. + +% Sample multitable: + +%   @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template} +%   @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff @tab third col +%   @item +%   first col stuff +%   @tab +%   second col stuff +%   @tab +%   third col +%   @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff +%   @tab Many paragraphs of text may be used in any column. +% +%         They will wrap at the width determined by the template. +%   @item@tab@tab This will be in third column. +%   @end multitable + +% Default dimensions may be reset by user. +% @multitableparskip is vertical space between paragraphs in table. +% @multitableparindent is paragraph indent in table. +% @multitablecolmargin is horizontal space to be left between columns. +% @multitablelinespace is space to leave between table items, baseline +%                                                            to baseline. +%   0pt means it depends on current normal line spacing. +% +\newskip\multitableparskip +\newskip\multitableparindent +\newdimen\multitablecolspace +\newskip\multitablelinespace +\multitableparskip=0pt +\multitableparindent=6pt +\multitablecolspace=12pt +\multitablelinespace=0pt + +% Macros used to set up halign preamble: +% +\let\endsetuptable\relax +\def\xendsetuptable{\endsetuptable} +\let\columnfractions\relax +\def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions} +\newif\ifsetpercent + +% #1 is the @columnfraction, usually a decimal number like .5, but might +% be just 1.  We just use it, whatever it is. +% +\def\pickupwholefraction#1 {% +  \global\advance\colcount by 1 +  \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{#1\hsize}% +  \setuptable +} + +\newcount\colcount +\def\setuptable#1{% +  \def\firstarg{#1}% +  \ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable +    \let\go = \relax +  \else +    \ifx\firstarg\xcolumnfractions +      \global\setpercenttrue +    \else +      \ifsetpercent +         \let\go\pickupwholefraction +      \else +         \global\advance\colcount by 1 +         \setbox0=\hbox{#1\unskip\space}% Add a normal word space as a +                   % separator; typically that is always in the input, anyway. +         \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}% +      \fi +    \fi +    \ifx\go\pickupwholefraction +      % Put the argument back for the \pickupwholefraction call, so +      % we'll always have a period there to be parsed. +      \def\go{\pickupwholefraction#1}% +    \else +      \let\go = \setuptable +    \fi% +  \fi +  \go +} + +% multitable-only commands. +% +% @headitem starts a heading row, which we typeset in bold. +% Assignments have to be global since we are inside the implicit group +% of an alignment entry.  \everycr resets \everytab so we don't have to +% undo it ourselves. +\def\headitemfont{\b}% for people to use in the template row; not changeable +\def\headitem{% +  \checkenv\multitable +  \crcr +  \global\everytab={\bf}% can't use \headitemfont since the parsing differs +  \the\everytab % for the first item +}% +% +% A \tab used to include \hskip1sp.  But then the space in a template +% line is not enough.  That is bad.  So let's go back to just `&' until +% we again encounter the problem the 1sp was intended to solve. +%					--karl, [email protected], 20apr99. +\def\tab{\checkenv\multitable &\the\everytab}% + +% @multitable ... @end multitable definitions: +% +\newtoks\everytab  % insert after every tab. +% +\envdef\multitable{% +  \vskip\parskip +  \startsavinginserts +  % +  % @item within a multitable starts a normal row. +  % We use \def instead of \let so that if one of the multitable entries +  % contains an @itemize, we don't choke on the \item (seen as \crcr aka +  % \endtemplate) expanding \doitemize. +  \def\item{\crcr}% +  % +  \tolerance=9500 +  \hbadness=9500 +  \setmultitablespacing +  \parskip=\multitableparskip +  \parindent=\multitableparindent +  \overfullrule=0pt +  \global\colcount=0 +  % +  \everycr = {% +    \noalign{% +      \global\everytab={}% +      \global\colcount=0 % Reset the column counter. +      % Check for saved footnotes, etc. +      \checkinserts +      % Keeps underfull box messages off when table breaks over pages. +      %\filbreak +	% Maybe so, but it also creates really weird page breaks when the +	% table breaks over pages. Wouldn't \vfil be better?  Wait until the +	% problem manifests itself, so it can be fixed for real --karl. +    }% +  }% +  % +  \parsearg\domultitable +} +\def\domultitable#1{% +  % To parse everything between @multitable and @item: +  \setuptable#1 \endsetuptable +  % +  % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will +  % be used as many times as user calls for columns. +  % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and +  % continue for many paragraphs if desired. +  \halign\bgroup &% +    \global\advance\colcount by 1 +    \multistrut +    \vtop{% +      % Use the current \colcount to find the correct column width: +      \hsize=\expandafter\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname +      % +      % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other +      % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after +      % the first one. +      % +      % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace +      % to the width of each template entry. +      % +      % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will +      % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip +      % will keep entries from bumping into each other.  Table will start at +      % left margin and final column will justify at right margin. +      % +      % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment. +      \rightskip=0pt +      \ifnum\colcount=1 +	% The first column will be indented with the surrounding text. +	\advance\hsize by\leftskip +      \else +	\ifsetpercent \else +	  % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize +	  % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace. +	  \advance\hsize by \multitablecolspace +	\fi +       % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace: +      \leftskip=\multitablecolspace +      \fi +      % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious +      % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the +      % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself. +      % For example: +      % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89 +      % @item @code{#} +      % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country. +      % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively +      % marking characters. +      \noindent\ignorespaces##\unskip\multistrut +    }\cr +} +\def\Emultitable{% +  \crcr +  \egroup % end the \halign +  \global\setpercentfalse +} + +\def\setmultitablespacing{% +  \def\multistrut{\strut}% just use the standard line spacing +  % +  % Compute \multitablelinespace (if not defined by user) for use in +  % \multitableparskip calculation.  We used define \multistrut based on +  % this, but (ironically) that caused the spacing to be off. +  % See bug-texinfo report from Werner Lemberg, 31 Oct 2004 12:52:20 +0100. +\ifdim\multitablelinespace=0pt +\setbox0=\vbox{X}\global\multitablelinespace=\the\baselineskip +\global\advance\multitablelinespace by-\ht0 +\fi +% Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of +% table. If not, do nothing. +%        If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace. +\ifdim\multitableparskip>\multitablelinespace +\global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace +\global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt % to keep parskip somewhat smaller +                                      % than skip between lines in the table. +\fi% +\ifdim\multitableparskip=0pt +\global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace +\global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt % to keep parskip somewhat smaller +                                      % than skip between lines in the table. +\fi} + + +\message{conditionals,} + +% @iftex, @ifnotdocbook, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext, +% @ifnotxml always succeed.  They currently do nothing; we don't +% attempt to check whether the conditionals are properly nested.  But we +% have to remember that they are conditionals, so that @end doesn't +% attempt to close an environment group. +% +\def\makecond#1{% +  \expandafter\let\csname #1\endcsname = \relax +  \expandafter\let\csname iscond.#1\endcsname = 1 +} +\makecond{iftex} +\makecond{ifnotdocbook} +\makecond{ifnothtml} +\makecond{ifnotinfo} +\makecond{ifnotplaintext} +\makecond{ifnotxml} + +% Ignore @ignore, @ifhtml, @ifinfo, and the like. +% +\def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}} +\def\documentdescription{\doignore{documentdescription}} +\def\docbook{\doignore{docbook}} +\def\html{\doignore{html}} +\def\ifdocbook{\doignore{ifdocbook}} +\def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}} +\def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}} +\def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex}} +\def\ifplaintext{\doignore{ifplaintext}} +\def\ifxml{\doignore{ifxml}} +\def\ignore{\doignore{ignore}} +\def\menu{\doignore{menu}} +\def\xml{\doignore{xml}} + +% Ignore text until a line `@end #1', keeping track of nested conditionals. +% +% A count to remember the depth of nesting. +\newcount\doignorecount + +\def\doignore#1{\begingroup +  % Scan in ``verbatim'' mode: +  \obeylines +  \catcode`\@ = \other +  \catcode`\{ = \other +  \catcode`\} = \other +  % +  % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants. +  \spaceisspace +  % +  % Count number of #1's that we've seen. +  \doignorecount = 0 +  % +  % Swallow text until we reach the matching `@end #1'. +  \dodoignore{#1}% +} + +{ \catcode`_=11 % We want to use \_STOP_ which cannot appear in texinfo source. +  \obeylines % +  % +  \gdef\dodoignore#1{% +    % #1 contains the command name as a string, e.g., `ifinfo'. +    % +    % Define a command to find the next `@end #1'. +    \long\def\doignoretext##1^^M@end #1{% +      \doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1\_STOP_}% +    % +    % And this command to find another #1 command, at the beginning of a +    % line.  (Otherwise, we would consider a line `@c @ifset', for +    % example, to count as an @ifset for nesting.) +    \long\def\doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1##2\_STOP_{\doignoreyyy{##2}\_STOP_}% +    % +    % And now expand that command. +    \doignoretext ^^M% +  }% +} + +\def\doignoreyyy#1{% +  \def\temp{#1}% +  \ifx\temp\empty			% Nothing found. +    \let\next\doignoretextzzz +  \else					% Found a nested condition, ... +    \advance\doignorecount by 1 +    \let\next\doignoretextyyy		% ..., look for another. +    % If we're here, #1 ends with ^^M\ifinfo (for example). +  \fi +  \next #1% the token \_STOP_ is present just after this macro. +} + +% We have to swallow the remaining "\_STOP_". +% +\def\doignoretextzzz#1{% +  \ifnum\doignorecount = 0	% We have just found the outermost @end. +    \let\next\enddoignore +  \else				% Still inside a nested condition. +    \advance\doignorecount by -1 +    \let\next\doignoretext      % Look for the next @end. +  \fi +  \next +} + +% Finish off ignored text. +{ \obeylines% +  % Ignore anything after the last `@end #1'; this matters in verbatim +  % environments, where otherwise the newline after an ignored conditional +  % would result in a blank line in the output. +  \gdef\enddoignore#1^^M{\endgroup\ignorespaces}% +} + + +% @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value. +% @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE. +% +% Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be +% empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our +% own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we +% didn't need it. +% We rely on the fact that \parsearg sets \catcode`\ =10. +% +\parseargdef\set{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy} +\def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{% +  {% +    \makevalueexpandable +    \def\temp{#2}% +    \edef\next{\gdef\makecsname{SET#1}}% +    \ifx\temp\empty +      \next{}% +    \else +      \setzzz#2\endsetzzz +    \fi +  }% +} +% Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted. +\def\setzzz#1 \endsetzzz{\next{#1}} + +% @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR. +% +\parseargdef\clear{% +  {% +    \makevalueexpandable +    \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax +  }% +} + +% @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo. +\def\value{\begingroup\makevalueexpandable\valuexxx} +\def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup} +{ +  \catcode`\- = \active \catcode`\_ = \active +  % +  \gdef\makevalueexpandable{% +    \let\value = \expandablevalue +    % We don't want these characters active, ... +    \catcode`\-=\other \catcode`\_=\other +    % ..., but we might end up with active ones in the argument if +    % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}, though. +    % So \let them to their normal equivalents. +    \let-\normaldash \let_\normalunderscore +  } +} + +% We have this subroutine so that we can handle at least some @value's +% properly in indexes (we call \makevalueexpandable in \indexdummies). +% The command has to be fully expandable (if the variable is set), since +% the result winds up in the index file.  This means that if the +% variable's value contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost certain +% it will fail (although perhaps we could fix that with sufficient work +% to do a one-level expansion on the result, instead of complete). +% +\def\expandablevalue#1{% +  \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax +    {[No value for ``#1'']}% +    \message{Variable `#1', used in @value, is not set.}% +  \else +    \csname SET#1\endcsname +  \fi +} + +% @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined +% with @set. +% +% To get special treatment of `@end ifset,' call \makeond and the redefine. +% +\makecond{ifset} +\def\ifset{\parsearg{\doifset{\let\next=\ifsetfail}}} +\def\doifset#1#2{% +  {% +    \makevalueexpandable +    \let\next=\empty +    \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#2\endcsname\relax +      #1% If not set, redefine \next. +    \fi +    \expandafter +  }\next +} +\def\ifsetfail{\doignore{ifset}} + +% @ifclear VAR ... @end executes the `...' iff VAR has never been +% defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear. +% +% The `\else' inside the `\doifset' parameter is a trick to reuse the +% above code: if the variable is not set, do nothing, if it is set, +% then redefine \next to \ifclearfail. +% +\makecond{ifclear} +\def\ifclear{\parsearg{\doifset{\else \let\next=\ifclearfail}}} +\def\ifclearfail{\doignore{ifclear}} + +% @ifcommandisdefined CMD ... @end executes the `...' if CMD (written +% without the @) is in fact defined.  We can only feasibly check at the +% TeX level, so something like `mathcode' is going to considered +% defined even though it is not a Texinfo command. +% +\makecond{ifcommanddefined} +\def\ifcommanddefined{\parsearg{\doifcmddefined{\let\next=\ifcmddefinedfail}}} +% +\def\doifcmddefined#1#2{{% +    \makevalueexpandable +    \let\next=\empty +    \expandafter\ifx\csname #2\endcsname\relax +      #1% If not defined, \let\next as above. +    \fi +    \expandafter +  }\next +} +\def\ifcmddefinedfail{\doignore{ifcommanddefined}} + +% @ifcommandnotdefined CMD ... handled similar to @ifclear above. +\makecond{ifcommandnotdefined} +\def\ifcommandnotdefined{% +  \parsearg{\doifcmddefined{\else \let\next=\ifcmdnotdefinedfail}}} +\def\ifcmdnotdefinedfail{\doignore{ifcommandnotdefined}} + +% Set the `txicommandconditionals' variable, so documents have a way to +% test if the @ifcommand...defined conditionals are available. +\set txicommandconditionals + +% @dircategory CATEGORY  -- specify a category of the dir file +% which this file should belong to.  Ignore this in TeX. +\let\dircategory=\comment + +% @defininfoenclose. +\let\definfoenclose=\comment + + +\message{indexing,} +% Index generation facilities + +% Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite +% except not \outer, so it can be used within macros and \if's. +\edef\newwrite{\makecsname{ptexnewwrite}} + +% \newindex {foo} defines an index named foo. +% It automatically defines \fooindex such that +% \fooindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index foo. +% It also defines \fooindfile to be the number of the output channel for +% the file that accumulates this index.  The file's extension is foo. +% The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long +% for the sake of vms. +% +\def\newindex#1{% +  \iflinks +    \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname +    \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 % Open the file +  \fi +  \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{%     % Define @#1index +    \noexpand\doindex{#1}} +} + +% @defindex foo  ==  \newindex{foo} +% +\def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex} + +% Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code. +% +\def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex} +% +\def\newcodeindex#1{% +  \iflinks +    \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname +    \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 +  \fi +  \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% +    \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}% +} + + +% @synindex foo bar    makes index foo feed into index bar. +% Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index. +% +% @syncodeindex foo bar   similar, but put all entries made for index foo +% inside @code. +% +\def\synindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\doindex{#1}{#2}} +\def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\docodeindex{#1}{#2}} + +% #1 is \doindex or \docodeindex, #2 the index getting redefined (foo), +% #3 the target index (bar). +\def\dosynindex#1#2#3{% +  % Only do \closeout if we haven't already done it, else we'll end up +  % closing the target index. +  \expandafter \ifx\csname donesynindex#2\endcsname \relax +    % The \closeout helps reduce unnecessary open files; the limit on the +    % Acorn RISC OS is a mere 16 files. +    \expandafter\closeout\csname#2indfile\endcsname +    \expandafter\let\csname donesynindex#2\endcsname = 1 +  \fi +  % redefine \fooindfile: +  \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp\expandafter=\csname#3indfile\endcsname +  \expandafter\let\csname#2indfile\endcsname=\temp +  % redefine \fooindex: +  \expandafter\xdef\csname#2index\endcsname{\noexpand#1{#3}}% +} + +% Define \doindex, the driver for all \fooindex macros. +% Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro, +%  and it is "foo", the name of the index. + +% \doindex just uses \parsearg; it calls \doind for the actual work. +% This is because \doind is more useful to call from other macros. + +% There is also \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic} +% which makes an entry in a two-level index such as the operation index. + +\def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singleindexer} +\def\singleindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}} + +% like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument. +\def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singlecodeindexer} +\def\singlecodeindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}} + +% Take care of Texinfo commands that can appear in an index entry. +% Since there are some commands we want to expand, and others we don't, +% we have to laboriously prevent expansion for those that we don't. +% +\def\indexdummies{% +  \escapechar = `\\     % use backslash in output files. +  \def\@{@}% change to @@ when we switch to @ as escape char in index files. +  \def\ {\realbackslash\space }% +  % +  % Need these unexpandable (because we define \tt as a dummy) +  % definitions when @{ or @} appear in index entry text.  Also, more +  % complicated, when \tex is in effect and \{ is a \delimiter again. +  % We can't use \lbracecmd and \rbracecmd because texindex assumes +  % braces and backslashes are used only as delimiters.  Perhaps we +  % should define @lbrace and @rbrace commands a la @comma. +  \def\{{{\tt\char123}}% +  \def\}{{\tt\char125}}% +  % +  % I don't entirely understand this, but when an index entry is +  % generated from a macro call, the \endinput which \scanmacro inserts +  % causes processing to be prematurely terminated.  This is, +  % apparently, because \indexsorttmp is fully expanded, and \endinput +  % is an expandable command.  The redefinition below makes \endinput +  % disappear altogether for that purpose -- although logging shows that +  % processing continues to some further point.  On the other hand, it +  % seems \endinput does not hurt in the printed index arg, since that +  % is still getting written without apparent harm. +  % +  % Sample source (mac-idx3.tex, reported by Graham Percival to +  % help-texinfo, 22may06): +  % @macro funindex {WORD} +  % @findex xyz +  % @end macro +  % ... +  % @funindex commtest +  % +  % The above is not enough to reproduce the bug, but it gives the flavor. +  % +  % Sample whatsit resulting: +  % .@write3{\entry{xyz}{@folio }{@code {xyz@endinput }}} +  % +  % So: +  \let\endinput = \empty +  % +  % Do the redefinitions. +  \commondummies +} + +% For the aux and toc files, @ is the escape character.  So we want to +% redefine everything using @ as the escape character (instead of +% \realbackslash, still used for index files).  When everything uses @, +% this will be simpler. +% +\def\atdummies{% +  \def\@{@@}% +  \def\ {@ }% +  \let\{ = \lbraceatcmd +  \let\} = \rbraceatcmd +  % +  % Do the redefinitions. +  \commondummies +  \otherbackslash +} + +% Called from \indexdummies and \atdummies. +% +\def\commondummies{% +  % +  % \definedummyword defines \#1 as \string\#1\space, thus effectively +  % preventing its expansion.  This is used only for control words, +  % not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect for +  % control characters, but is needed to separate the control word +  % from whatever follows. +  % +  % For control letters, we have \definedummyletter, which omits the +  % space. +  % +  % These can be used both for control words that take an argument and +  % those that do not.  If it is followed by {arg} in the input, then +  % that will dutifully get written to the index (or wherever). +  % +  \def\definedummyword  ##1{\def##1{\string##1\space}}% +  \def\definedummyletter##1{\def##1{\string##1}}% +  \let\definedummyaccent\definedummyletter +  % +  \commondummiesnofonts +  % +  \definedummyletter\_% +  \definedummyletter\-% +  % +  % Non-English letters. +  \definedummyword\AA +  \definedummyword\AE +  \definedummyword\DH +  \definedummyword\L +  \definedummyword\O +  \definedummyword\OE +  \definedummyword\TH +  \definedummyword\aa +  \definedummyword\ae +  \definedummyword\dh +  \definedummyword\exclamdown +  \definedummyword\l +  \definedummyword\o +  \definedummyword\oe +  \definedummyword\ordf +  \definedummyword\ordm +  \definedummyword\questiondown +  \definedummyword\ss +  \definedummyword\th +  % +  % Although these internal commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do. +  \definedummyword\bf +  \definedummyword\gtr +  \definedummyword\hat +  \definedummyword\less +  \definedummyword\sf +  \definedummyword\sl +  \definedummyword\tclose +  \definedummyword\tt +  % +  \definedummyword\LaTeX +  \definedummyword\TeX +  % +  % Assorted special characters. +  \definedummyword\arrow +  \definedummyword\bullet +  \definedummyword\comma +  \definedummyword\copyright +  \definedummyword\registeredsymbol +  \definedummyword\dots +  \definedummyword\enddots +  \definedummyword\entrybreak +  \definedummyword\equiv +  \definedummyword\error +  \definedummyword\euro +  \definedummyword\expansion +  \definedummyword\geq +  \definedummyword\guillemetleft +  \definedummyword\guillemetright +  \definedummyword\guilsinglleft +  \definedummyword\guilsinglright +  \definedummyword\lbracechar +  \definedummyword\leq +  \definedummyword\minus +  \definedummyword\ogonek +  \definedummyword\pounds +  \definedummyword\point +  \definedummyword\print +  \definedummyword\quotedblbase +  \definedummyword\quotedblleft +  \definedummyword\quotedblright +  \definedummyword\quoteleft +  \definedummyword\quoteright +  \definedummyword\quotesinglbase +  \definedummyword\rbracechar +  \definedummyword\result +  \definedummyword\textdegree +  % +  % We want to disable all macros so that they are not expanded by \write. +  \macrolist +  % +  \normalturnoffactive +  % +  % Handle some cases of @value -- where it does not contain any +  % (non-fully-expandable) commands. +  \makevalueexpandable +} + +% \commondummiesnofonts: common to \commondummies and \indexnofonts. +% +\def\commondummiesnofonts{% +  % Control letters and accents. +  \definedummyletter\!% +  \definedummyaccent\"% +  \definedummyaccent\'% +  \definedummyletter\*% +  \definedummyaccent\,% +  \definedummyletter\.% +  \definedummyletter\/% +  \definedummyletter\:% +  \definedummyaccent\=% +  \definedummyletter\?% +  \definedummyaccent\^% +  \definedummyaccent\`% +  \definedummyaccent\~% +  \definedummyword\u +  \definedummyword\v +  \definedummyword\H +  \definedummyword\dotaccent +  \definedummyword\ogonek +  \definedummyword\ringaccent +  \definedummyword\tieaccent +  \definedummyword\ubaraccent +  \definedummyword\udotaccent +  \definedummyword\dotless +  % +  % Texinfo font commands. +  \definedummyword\b +  \definedummyword\i +  \definedummyword\r +  \definedummyword\sansserif +  \definedummyword\sc +  \definedummyword\slanted +  \definedummyword\t +  % +  % Commands that take arguments. +  \definedummyword\abbr +  \definedummyword\acronym +  \definedummyword\anchor +  \definedummyword\cite +  \definedummyword\code +  \definedummyword\command +  \definedummyword\dfn +  \definedummyword\dmn +  \definedummyword\email +  \definedummyword\emph +  \definedummyword\env +  \definedummyword\file +  \definedummyword\image +  \definedummyword\indicateurl +  \definedummyword\inforef +  \definedummyword\kbd +  \definedummyword\key +  \definedummyword\math +  \definedummyword\option +  \definedummyword\pxref +  \definedummyword\ref +  \definedummyword\samp +  \definedummyword\strong +  \definedummyword\tie +  \definedummyword\uref +  \definedummyword\url +  \definedummyword\var +  \definedummyword\verb +  \definedummyword\w +  \definedummyword\xref +} + +% \indexnofonts is used when outputting the strings to sort the index +% by, and when constructing control sequence names.  It eliminates all +% control sequences and just writes whatever the best ASCII sort string +% would be for a given command (usually its argument). +% +\def\indexnofonts{% +  % Accent commands should become @asis. +  \def\definedummyaccent##1{\let##1\asis}% +  % We can just ignore other control letters. +  \def\definedummyletter##1{\let##1\empty}% +  % All control words become @asis by default; overrides below. +  \let\definedummyword\definedummyaccent +  % +  \commondummiesnofonts +  % +  % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command +  % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc. +  % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands. +  %\let\tt=\asis +  % +  \def\ { }% +  \def\@{@}% +  \def\_{\normalunderscore}% +  \def\-{}% @- shouldn't affect sorting +  % +  % Unfortunately, texindex is not prepared to handle braces in the +  % content at all.  So for index sorting, we map @{ and @} to strings +  % starting with |, since that ASCII character is between ASCII { and }. +  \def\{{|a}% +  \def\lbracechar{|a}% +  % +  \def\}{|b}% +  \def\rbracechar{|b}% +  % +  % Non-English letters. +  \def\AA{AA}% +  \def\AE{AE}% +  \def\DH{DZZ}% +  \def\L{L}% +  \def\OE{OE}% +  \def\O{O}% +  \def\TH{ZZZ}% +  \def\aa{aa}% +  \def\ae{ae}% +  \def\dh{dzz}% +  \def\exclamdown{!}% +  \def\l{l}% +  \def\oe{oe}% +  \def\ordf{a}% +  \def\ordm{o}% +  \def\o{o}% +  \def\questiondown{?}% +  \def\ss{ss}% +  \def\th{zzz}% +  % +  \def\LaTeX{LaTeX}% +  \def\TeX{TeX}% +  % +  % Assorted special characters. +  % (The following {} will end up in the sort string, but that's ok.) +  \def\arrow{->}% +  \def\bullet{bullet}% +  \def\comma{,}% +  \def\copyright{copyright}% +  \def\dots{...}% +  \def\enddots{...}% +  \def\equiv{==}% +  \def\error{error}% +  \def\euro{euro}% +  \def\expansion{==>}% +  \def\geq{>=}% +  \def\guillemetleft{<<}% +  \def\guillemetright{>>}% +  \def\guilsinglleft{<}% +  \def\guilsinglright{>}% +  \def\leq{<=}% +  \def\minus{-}% +  \def\point{.}% +  \def\pounds{pounds}% +  \def\print{-|}% +  \def\quotedblbase{"}% +  \def\quotedblleft{"}% +  \def\quotedblright{"}% +  \def\quoteleft{`}% +  \def\quoteright{'}% +  \def\quotesinglbase{,}% +  \def\registeredsymbol{R}% +  \def\result{=>}% +  \def\textdegree{o}% +  % +  \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexlquoteignore\endcsname\relax +  \else \indexlquoteignore \fi +  % +  % We need to get rid of all macros, leaving only the arguments (if present). +  % Of course this is not nearly correct, but it is the best we can do for now. +  % makeinfo does not expand macros in the argument to @deffn, which ends up +  % writing an index entry, and texindex isn't prepared for an index sort entry +  % that starts with \. +  % +  % Since macro invocations are followed by braces, we can just redefine them +  % to take a single TeX argument.  The case of a macro invocation that +  % goes to end-of-line is not handled. +  % +  \macrolist +} + +% Undocumented (for FSFS 2nd ed.): @set txiindexlquoteignore makes us +% ignore left quotes in the sort term. +{\catcode`\`=\active + \gdef\indexlquoteignore{\let`=\empty}} + +\let\indexbackslash=0  %overridden during \printindex. +\let\SETmarginindex=\relax % put index entries in margin (undocumented)? + +% Most index entries go through here, but \dosubind is the general case. +% #1 is the index name, #2 is the entry text. +\def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}{}} + +% Workhorse for all \fooindexes. +% #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there, #3 is subentry -- +% empty if called from \doind, as we usually are (the main exception +% is with most defuns, which call us directly). +% +\def\dosubind#1#2#3{% +  \iflinks +  {% +    % Store the main index entry text (including the third arg). +    \toks0 = {#2}% +    % If third arg is present, precede it with a space. +    \def\thirdarg{#3}% +    \ifx\thirdarg\empty \else +      \toks0 = \expandafter{\the\toks0 \space #3}% +    \fi +    % +    \edef\writeto{\csname#1indfile\endcsname}% +    % +    \safewhatsit\dosubindwrite +  }% +  \fi +} + +% Write the entry in \toks0 to the index file: +% +\def\dosubindwrite{% +  % Put the index entry in the margin if desired. +  \ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else +    \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt \the\toks0}}% +  \fi +  % +  % Remember, we are within a group. +  \indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage +  \def\backslashcurfont{\indexbackslash}% \indexbackslash isn't defined now +      % so it will be output as is; and it will print as backslash. +  % +  % Process the index entry with all font commands turned off, to +  % get the string to sort by. +  {\indexnofonts +   \edef\temp{\the\toks0}% need full expansion +   \xdef\indexsorttmp{\temp}% +  }% +  % +  % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key and +  % the original text, including any font commands.  We write +  % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file (four in the +  % subentry case), texindex reduces to two when writing the .??s +  % sorted result. +  \edef\temp{% +    \write\writeto{% +      \string\entry{\indexsorttmp}{\noexpand\folio}{\the\toks0}}% +  }% +  \temp +} + +% Take care of unwanted page breaks/skips around a whatsit: +% +% If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it +% by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting +% the skip again.  Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the +% \write or \pdfdest will make \lastskip zero.  The result is that +% sequences like this: +% @end defun +% @tindex whatever +% @defun ... +% will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the +% start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of +% the previous defun. +% +% But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode.  We +% don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph. +% +% Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too. +% +% But wait, there is a catch there: +% We'll have to check whether \lastskip is zero skip.  \ifdim is not +% sufficient for this purpose, as it ignores stretch and shrink parts +% of the skip.  The only way seems to be to check the textual +% representation of the skip. +% +% The following is almost like \def\zeroskipmacro{0.0pt} except that +% the ``p'' and ``t'' characters have catcode \other, not 11 (letter). +% +\edef\zeroskipmacro{\expandafter\the\csname z@skip\endcsname} +% +\newskip\whatsitskip +\newcount\whatsitpenalty +% +% ..., ready, GO: +% +\def\safewhatsit#1{\ifhmode +  #1% + \else +  % \lastskip and \lastpenalty cannot both be nonzero simultaneously. +  \whatsitskip = \lastskip +  \edef\lastskipmacro{\the\lastskip}% +  \whatsitpenalty = \lastpenalty +  % +  % If \lastskip is nonzero, that means the last item was a +  % skip.  And since a skip is discardable, that means this +  % -\whatsitskip glue we're inserting is preceded by a +  % non-discardable item, therefore it is not a potential +  % breakpoint, therefore no \nobreak needed. +  \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro +  \else +    \vskip-\whatsitskip +  \fi +  % +  #1% +  % +  \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro +    % If \lastskip was zero, perhaps the last item was a penalty, and +    % perhaps it was >=10000, e.g., a \nobreak.  In that case, we want +    % to re-insert the same penalty (values >10000 are used for various +    % signals); since we just inserted a non-discardable item, any +    % following glue (such as a \parskip) would be a breakpoint.  For example: +    %   @deffn deffn-whatever +    %   @vindex index-whatever +    %   Description. +    % would allow a break between the index-whatever whatsit +    % and the "Description." paragraph. +    \ifnum\whatsitpenalty>9999 \penalty\whatsitpenalty \fi +  \else +    % On the other hand, if we had a nonzero \lastskip, +    % this make-up glue would be preceded by a non-discardable item +    % (the whatsit from the \write), so we must insert a \nobreak. +    \nobreak\vskip\whatsitskip +  \fi +\fi} + +% The index entry written in the file actually looks like +%  \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic} +% or +%  \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}{subtopic} +% The texindex program reads in these files and writes files +% containing these kinds of lines: +%  \initial {c} +%     before the first topic whose initial is c +%  \entry {topic}{pagelist} +%     for a topic that is used without subtopics +%  \primary {topic} +%     for the beginning of a topic that is used with subtopics +%  \secondary {subtopic}{pagelist} +%     for each subtopic. + +% Define the user-accessible indexing commands +% @findex, @vindex, @kindex, @cindex. + +\def\findex {\fnindex} +\def\kindex {\kyindex} +\def\cindex {\cpindex} +\def\vindex {\vrindex} +\def\tindex {\tpindex} +\def\pindex {\pgindex} + +\def\cindexsub {\begingroup\obeylines\cindexsub} +{\obeylines % +\gdef\cindexsub "#1" #2^^M{\endgroup % +\dosubind{cp}{#2}{#1}}} + +% Define the macros used in formatting output of the sorted index material. + +% @printindex causes a particular index (the ??s file) to get printed. +% It does not print any chapter heading (usually an @unnumbered). +% +\parseargdef\printindex{\begingroup +  \dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}% +  % +  \smallfonts \rm +  \tolerance = 9500 +  \plainfrenchspacing +  \everypar = {}% don't want the \kern\-parindent from indentation suppression. +  % +  % See if the index file exists and is nonempty. +  % Change catcode of @ here so that if the index file contains +  % \initial {@} +  % as its first line, TeX doesn't complain about mismatched braces +  % (because it thinks @} is a control sequence). +  \catcode`\@ = 11 +  \openin 1 \jobname.#1s +  \ifeof 1 +    % \enddoublecolumns gets confused if there is no text in the index, +    % and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the +    % index.  The easiest way to prevent this problem is to make sure +    % there is some text. +    \putwordIndexNonexistent +  \else +    % +    % If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof +    % false.  We have to make TeX try to read something from the file, so +    % it can discover if there is anything in it. +    \read 1 to \temp +    \ifeof 1 +      \putwordIndexIsEmpty +    \else +      % Index files are almost Texinfo source, but we use \ as the escape +      % character.  It would be better to use @, but that's too big a change +      % to make right now. +      \def\indexbackslash{\backslashcurfont}% +      \catcode`\\ = 0 +      \escapechar = `\\ +      \begindoublecolumns +      \input \jobname.#1s +      \enddoublecolumns +    \fi +  \fi +  \closein 1 +\endgroup} + +% These macros are used by the sorted index file itself. +% Change them to control the appearance of the index. + +\def\initial#1{{% +  % Some minor font changes for the special characters. +  \let\tentt=\sectt \let\tt=\sectt \let\sf=\sectt +  % +  % Remove any glue we may have, we'll be inserting our own. +  \removelastskip +  % +  % We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus. +  \nobreak +  \vskip 0pt plus 3\baselineskip +  \penalty 0 +  \vskip 0pt plus -3\baselineskip +  % +  % Typeset the initial.  Making this add up to a whole number of +  % baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column +  % to column.  It still won't often be perfect, because of the stretch +  % we need before each entry, but it's better. +  % +  % No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns. +  \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus .5\baselineskip +  \leftline{\secbf #1}% +  % Do our best not to break after the initial. +  \nobreak +  \vskip .33\baselineskip plus .1\baselineskip +}} + +% \entry typesets a paragraph consisting of the text (#1), dot leaders, and +% then page number (#2) flushed to the right margin.  It is used for index +% and table of contents entries.  The paragraph is indented by \leftskip. +% +% A straightforward implementation would start like this: +%	\def\entry#1#2{... +% But this freezes the catcodes in the argument, and can cause problems to +% @code, which sets - active.  This problem was fixed by a kludge--- +% ``-'' was active throughout whole index, but this isn't really right. +% The right solution is to prevent \entry from swallowing the whole text. +%                                 --kasal, 21nov03 +\def\entry{% +  \begingroup +    % +    % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't +    % affect previous text. +    \par +    % +    % Do not fill out the last line with white space. +    \parfillskip = 0in +    % +    % No extra space above this paragraph. +    \parskip = 0in +    % +    % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines. +    \finalhyphendemerits = 0 +    % +    % \hangindent is only relevant when the entry text and page number +    % don't both fit on one line.  In that case, bob suggests starting the +    % dots pretty far over on the line.  Unfortunately, a large +    % indentation looks wrong when the entry text itself is broken across +    % lines.  So we use a small indentation and put up with long leaders. +    % +    % \hangafter is reset to 1 (which is the value we want) at the start +    % of each paragraph, so we need not do anything with that. +    \hangindent = 2em +    % +    % When the entry text needs to be broken, just fill out the first line +    % with blank space. +    \rightskip = 0pt plus1fil +    % +    % A bit of stretch before each entry for the benefit of balancing +    % columns. +    \vskip 0pt plus1pt +    % +    % When reading the text of entry, convert explicit line breaks +    % from @* into spaces.  The user might give these in long section +    % titles, for instance. +    \def\*{\unskip\space\ignorespaces}% +    \def\entrybreak{\hfil\break}% +    % +    % Swallow the left brace of the text (first parameter): +    \afterassignment\doentry +    \let\temp = +} +\def\entrybreak{\unskip\space\ignorespaces}% +\def\doentry{% +    \bgroup % Instead of the swallowed brace. +      \noindent +      \aftergroup\finishentry +      % And now comes the text of the entry. +} +\def\finishentry#1{% +    % #1 is the page number. +    % +    % The following is kludged to not output a line of dots in the index if +    % there are no page numbers.  The next person who breaks this will be +    % cursed by a Unix daemon. +    \setbox\boxA = \hbox{#1}% +    \ifdim\wd\boxA = 0pt +      \ % +    \else +      % +      % If we must, put the page number on a line of its own, and fill out +      % this line with blank space.  (The \hfil is overwhelmed with the +      % fill leaders glue in \indexdotfill if the page number does fit.) +      \hfil\penalty50 +      \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number. +      % +      % The `\ ' here is removed by the implicit \unskip that TeX does as +      % part of (the primitive) \par.  Without it, a spurious underfull +      % \hbox ensues. +      \ifpdf +	\pdfgettoks#1.% +	\ \the\toksA +      \else +	\ #1% +      \fi +    \fi +    \par +  \endgroup +} + +% Like plain.tex's \dotfill, except uses up at least 1 em. +\def\indexdotfill{\cleaders +  \hbox{$\mathsurround=0pt \mkern1.5mu.\mkern1.5mu$}\hskip 1em plus 1fill} + +\def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}} + +\newskip\secondaryindent \secondaryindent=0.5cm +\def\secondary#1#2{{% +  \parfillskip=0in +  \parskip=0in +  \hangindent=1in +  \hangafter=1 +  \noindent\hskip\secondaryindent\hbox{#1}\indexdotfill +  \ifpdf +    \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph. +  \else +    #2 +  \fi +  \par +}} + +% Define two-column mode, which we use to typeset indexes. +% Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416, which is to say, +% the manmac.tex format used to print the TeXbook itself. +\catcode`\@=11 + +\newbox\partialpage +\newdimen\doublecolumnhsize + +\def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup % ended by \enddoublecolumns +  % Grab any single-column material above us. +  \output = {% +    % +    % Here is a possibility not foreseen in manmac: if we accumulate a +    % whole lot of material, we might end up calling this \output +    % routine twice in a row (see the doublecol-lose test, which is +    % essentially a couple of indexes with @setchapternewpage off).  In +    % that case we just ship out what is in \partialpage with the normal +    % output routine.  Generally, \partialpage will be empty when this +    % runs and this will be a no-op.  See the indexspread.tex test case. +    \ifvoid\partialpage \else +      \onepageout{\pagecontents\partialpage}% +    \fi +    % +    \global\setbox\partialpage = \vbox{% +      % Unvbox the main output page. +      \unvbox\PAGE +      \kern-\topskip \kern\baselineskip +    }% +  }% +  \eject % run that output routine to set \partialpage +  % +  % Use the double-column output routine for subsequent pages. +  \output = {\doublecolumnout}% +  % +  % Change the page size parameters.  We could do this once outside this +  % routine, in each of @smallbook, @afourpaper, and the default 8.5x11 +  % format, but then we repeat the same computation.  Repeating a couple +  % of assignments once per index is clearly meaningless for the +  % execution time, so we may as well do it in one place. +  % +  % First we halve the line length, less a little for the gutter between +  % the columns.  We compute the gutter based on the line length, so it +  % changes automatically with the paper format.  The magic constant +  % below is chosen so that the gutter has the same value (well, +-<1pt) +  % as it did when we hard-coded it. +  % +  % We put the result in a separate register, \doublecolumhsize, so we +  % can restore it in \pagesofar, after \hsize itself has (potentially) +  % been clobbered. +  % +  \doublecolumnhsize = \hsize +    \advance\doublecolumnhsize by -.04154\hsize +    \divide\doublecolumnhsize by 2 +  \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize +  % +  % Double the \vsize as well.  (We don't need a separate register here, +  % since nobody clobbers \vsize.) +  \vsize = 2\vsize +} + +% The double-column output routine for all double-column pages except +% the last. +% +\def\doublecolumnout{% +  \splittopskip=\topskip \splitmaxdepth=\maxdepth +  % Get the available space for the double columns -- the normal +  % (undoubled) page height minus any material left over from the +  % previous page. +  \dimen@ = \vsize +  \divide\dimen@ by 2 +  \advance\dimen@ by -\ht\partialpage +  % +  % box0 will be the left-hand column, box2 the right. +  \setbox0=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ \setbox2=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ +  \onepageout\pagesofar +  \unvbox255 +  \penalty\outputpenalty +} +% +% Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material, +% followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2. +\def\pagesofar{% +  \unvbox\partialpage +  % +  \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize +  \wd0=\hsize \wd2=\hsize +  \hbox to\pagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}% +} +% +% All done with double columns. +\def\enddoublecolumns{% +  % The following penalty ensures that the page builder is exercised +  % _before_ we change the output routine.  This is necessary in the +  % following situation: +  % +  % The last section of the index consists only of a single entry. +  % Before this section, \pagetotal is less than \pagegoal, so no +  % break occurs before the last section starts.  However, the last +  % section, consisting of \initial and the single \entry, does not +  % fit on the page and has to be broken off.  Without the following +  % penalty the page builder will not be exercised until \eject +  % below, and by that time we'll already have changed the output +  % routine to the \balancecolumns version, so the next-to-last +  % double-column page will be processed with \balancecolumns, which +  % is wrong:  The two columns will go to the main vertical list, with +  % the broken-off section in the recent contributions.  As soon as +  % the output routine finishes, TeX starts reconsidering the page +  % break.  The two columns and the broken-off section both fit on the +  % page, because the two columns now take up only half of the page +  % goal.  When TeX sees \eject from below which follows the final +  % section, it invokes the new output routine that we've set after +  % \balancecolumns below; \onepageout will try to fit the two columns +  % and the final section into the vbox of \pageheight (see +  % \pagebody), causing an overfull box. +  % +  % Note that glue won't work here, because glue does not exercise the +  % page builder, unlike penalties (see The TeXbook, pp. 280-281). +  \penalty0 +  % +  \output = {% +    % Split the last of the double-column material.  Leave it on the +    % current page, no automatic page break. +    \balancecolumns +    % +    % If we end up splitting too much material for the current page, +    % though, there will be another page break right after this \output +    % invocation ends.  Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not +    % want to call it again.  Therefore, reset \output to its normal +    % definition right away.  (We hope \balancecolumns will never be +    % called on to balance too much material, but if it is, this makes +    % the output somewhat more palatable.) +    \global\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}% +  }% +  \eject +  \endgroup % started in \begindoublecolumns +  % +  % \pagegoal was set to the doubled \vsize above, since we restarted +  % the current page.  We're now back to normal single-column +  % typesetting, so reset \pagegoal to the normal \vsize (after the +  % \endgroup where \vsize got restored). +  \pagegoal = \vsize +} +% +% Called at the end of the double column material. +\def\balancecolumns{% +  \setbox0 = \vbox{\unvbox255}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120. +  \dimen@ = \ht0 +  \advance\dimen@ by \topskip +  \advance\dimen@ by-\baselineskip +  \divide\dimen@ by 2 % target to split to +  %debug\message{final 2-column material height=\the\ht0, target=\the\dimen@.}% +  \splittopskip = \topskip +  % Loop until we get a decent breakpoint. +  {% +    \vbadness = 10000 +    \loop +      \global\setbox3 = \copy0 +      \global\setbox1 = \vsplit3 to \dimen@ +    \ifdim\ht3>\dimen@ +      \global\advance\dimen@ by 1pt +    \repeat +  }% +  %debug\message{split to \the\dimen@, column heights: \the\ht1, \the\ht3.}% +  \setbox0=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox1}% +  \setbox2=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox3}% +  % +  \pagesofar +} +\catcode`\@ = \other + + +\message{sectioning,} +% Chapters, sections, etc. + +% Let's start with @part. +\outer\parseargdef\part{\partzzz{#1}} +\def\partzzz#1{% +  \chapoddpage +  \null +  \vskip.3\vsize  % move it down on the page a bit +  \begingroup +    \noindent \titlefonts\rmisbold #1\par % the text +    \let\lastnode=\empty      % no node to associate with +    \writetocentry{part}{#1}{}% but put it in the toc +    \headingsoff              % no headline or footline on the part page +    \chapoddpage +  \endgroup +} + +% \unnumberedno is an oxymoron.  But we count the unnumbered +% sections so that we can refer to them unambiguously in the pdf +% outlines by their "section number".  We avoid collisions with chapter +% numbers by starting them at 10000.  (If a document ever has 10000 +% chapters, we're in trouble anyway, I'm sure.) +\newcount\unnumberedno \unnumberedno = 10000 +\newcount\chapno +\newcount\secno        \secno=0 +\newcount\subsecno     \subsecno=0 +\newcount\subsubsecno  \subsubsecno=0 + +% This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ... +\newcount\appendixno  \appendixno = `\@ +% +% \def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno} +% We do the following ugly conditional instead of the above simple +% construct for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual +% letter in the expansion, not just typeset. +% +\def\appendixletter{% +  \ifnum\appendixno=`A A% +  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B% +  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`C C% +  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`D D% +  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`E E% +  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`F F% +  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`G G% +  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`H H% +  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`I I% +  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`J J% +  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`K K% +  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`L L% +  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`M M% +  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`N N% +  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`O O% +  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`P P% +  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Q Q% +  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`R R% +  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`S S% +  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`T T% +  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`U U% +  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`V V% +  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`W W% +  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`X X% +  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Y Y% +  \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Z Z% +  % The \the is necessary, despite appearances, because \appendixletter is +  % expanded while writing the .toc file.  \char\appendixno is not +  % expandable, thus it is written literally, thus all appendixes come out +  % with the same letter (or @) in the toc without it. +  \else\char\the\appendixno +  \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi +  \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi} + +% Each @chapter defines these (using marks) as the number+name, number +% and name of the chapter.  Page headings and footings can use +% these.  @section does likewise. +\def\thischapter{} +\def\thischapternum{} +\def\thischaptername{} +\def\thissection{} +\def\thissectionnum{} +\def\thissectionname{} + +\newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level +\newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raisesections/@lowersections modify this count + +% @raisesections: treat @section as chapter, @subsection as section, etc. +\def\raisesections{\global\advance\secbase by -1} +\let\up=\raisesections % original BFox name + +% @lowersections: treat @chapter as section, @section as subsection, etc. +\def\lowersections{\global\advance\secbase by 1} +\let\down=\lowersections % original BFox name + +% we only have subsub. +\chardef\maxseclevel = 3 +% +% A numbered section within an unnumbered changes to unnumbered too. +% To achieve this, remember the "biggest" unnum. sec. we are currently in: +\chardef\unnlevel = \maxseclevel +% +% Trace whether the current chapter is an appendix or not: +% \chapheadtype is "N" or "A", unnumbered chapters are ignored. +\def\chapheadtype{N} + +% Choose a heading macro +% #1 is heading type +% #2 is heading level +% #3 is text for heading +\def\genhead#1#2#3{% +  % Compute the abs. sec. level: +  \absseclevel=#2 +  \advance\absseclevel by \secbase +  % Make sure \absseclevel doesn't fall outside the range: +  \ifnum \absseclevel < 0 +    \absseclevel = 0 +  \else +    \ifnum \absseclevel > 3 +      \absseclevel = 3 +    \fi +  \fi +  % The heading type: +  \def\headtype{#1}% +  \if \headtype U% +    \ifnum \absseclevel < \unnlevel +      \chardef\unnlevel = \absseclevel +    \fi +  \else +    % Check for appendix sections: +    \ifnum \absseclevel = 0 +      \edef\chapheadtype{\headtype}% +    \else +      \if \headtype A\if \chapheadtype N% +	\errmessage{@appendix... within a non-appendix chapter}% +      \fi\fi +    \fi +    % Check for numbered within unnumbered: +    \ifnum \absseclevel > \unnlevel +      \def\headtype{U}% +    \else +      \chardef\unnlevel = 3 +    \fi +  \fi +  % Now print the heading: +  \if \headtype U% +    \ifcase\absseclevel +	\unnumberedzzz{#3}% +    \or \unnumberedseczzz{#3}% +    \or \unnumberedsubseczzz{#3}% +    \or \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#3}% +    \fi +  \else +    \if \headtype A% +      \ifcase\absseclevel +	  \appendixzzz{#3}% +      \or \appendixsectionzzz{#3}% +      \or \appendixsubseczzz{#3}% +      \or \appendixsubsubseczzz{#3}% +      \fi +    \else +      \ifcase\absseclevel +	  \chapterzzz{#3}% +      \or \seczzz{#3}% +      \or \numberedsubseczzz{#3}% +      \or \numberedsubsubseczzz{#3}% +      \fi +    \fi +  \fi +  \suppressfirstparagraphindent +} + +% an interface: +\def\numhead{\genhead N} +\def\apphead{\genhead A} +\def\unnmhead{\genhead U} + +% @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered.  Increment top-level counter, reset +% all lower-level sectioning counters to zero. +% +% Also set \chaplevelprefix, which we prepend to @float sequence numbers +% (e.g., figures), q.v.  By default (before any chapter), that is empty. +\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty +% +\outer\parseargdef\chapter{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz +\def\chapterzzz#1{% +  % section resetting is \global in case the chapter is in a group, such +  % as an @include file. +  \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 +    \global\advance\chapno by 1 +  % +  % Used for \float. +  \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\the\chapno.}% +  \resetallfloatnos +  % +  % \putwordChapter can contain complex things in translations. +  \toks0=\expandafter{\putwordChapter}% +  \message{\the\toks0 \space \the\chapno}% +  % +  % Write the actual heading. +  \chapmacro{#1}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno}% +  % +  % So @section and the like are numbered underneath this chapter. +  \global\let\section = \numberedsec +  \global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec +  \global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec +} + +\outer\parseargdef\appendix{\apphead0{#1}} % normally calls appendixzzz +% +\def\appendixzzz#1{% +  \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 +    \global\advance\appendixno by 1 +  \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\appendixletter.}% +  \resetallfloatnos +  % +  % \putwordAppendix can contain complex things in translations. +  \toks0=\expandafter{\putwordAppendix}% +  \message{\the\toks0 \space \appendixletter}% +  % +  \chapmacro{#1}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter}% +  % +  \global\let\section = \appendixsec +  \global\let\subsection = \appendixsubsec +  \global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec +} + +% normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz: +\outer\parseargdef\unnumbered{\unnmhead0{#1}} +\def\unnumberedzzz#1{% +  \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 +    \global\advance\unnumberedno by 1 +  % +  % Since an unnumbered has no number, no prefix for figures. +  \global\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty +  \resetallfloatnos +  % +  % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the +  % argument to \message.  Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX +  % expanded them.  For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX +  % expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant +  % to be executed, not expanded). +  % +  % Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear +  % as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself.  We use +  % \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once, +  % simply yielding the contents of <toks register>.  (We also do this for +  % the toc entries.) +  \toks0 = {#1}% +  \message{(\the\toks0)}% +  % +  \chapmacro{#1}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno}% +  % +  \global\let\section = \unnumberedsec +  \global\let\subsection = \unnumberedsubsec +  \global\let\subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec +} + +% @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered. +\outer\parseargdef\centerchap{% +  % Well, we could do the following in a group, but that would break +  % an assumption that \chapmacro is called at the outermost level. +  % Thus we are safer this way:		--kasal, 24feb04 +  \let\centerparametersmaybe = \centerparameters +  \unnmhead0{#1}% +  \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax +} + +% @top is like @unnumbered. +\let\top\unnumbered + +% Sections. +% +\outer\parseargdef\numberedsec{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz +\def\seczzz#1{% +  \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0  \global\advance\secno by 1 +  \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}% +} + +% normally calls appendixsectionzzz: +\outer\parseargdef\appendixsection{\apphead1{#1}} +\def\appendixsectionzzz#1{% +  \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0  \global\advance\secno by 1 +  \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter.\the\secno}% +} +\let\appendixsec\appendixsection + +% normally calls unnumberedseczzz: +\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsec{\unnmhead1{#1}} +\def\unnumberedseczzz#1{% +  \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0  \global\advance\secno by 1 +  \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno}% +} + +% Subsections. +% +% normally calls numberedsubseczzz: +\outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsec{\numhead2{#1}} +\def\numberedsubseczzz#1{% +  \global\subsubsecno=0  \global\advance\subsecno by 1 +  \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}% +} + +% normally calls appendixsubseczzz: +\outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsec{\apphead2{#1}} +\def\appendixsubseczzz#1{% +  \global\subsubsecno=0  \global\advance\subsecno by 1 +  \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yappendix}% +                 {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}% +} + +% normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz: +\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsec{\unnmhead2{#1}} +\def\unnumberedsubseczzz#1{% +  \global\subsubsecno=0  \global\advance\subsecno by 1 +  \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynothing}% +                 {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}% +} + +% Subsubsections. +% +% normally numberedsubsubseczzz: +\outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsubsec{\numhead3{#1}} +\def\numberedsubsubseczzz#1{% +  \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1 +  \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynumbered}% +                 {\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}% +} + +% normally appendixsubsubseczzz: +\outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsubsec{\apphead3{#1}} +\def\appendixsubsubseczzz#1{% +  \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1 +  \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yappendix}% +                 {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}% +} + +% normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz: +\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsubsec{\unnmhead3{#1}} +\def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz#1{% +  \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1 +  \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynothing}% +                 {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}% +} + +% These macros control what the section commands do, according +% to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered). +% Define them by default for a numbered chapter. +\let\section = \numberedsec +\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec +\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec + +% Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading + +\def\majorheading{% +  {\advance\chapheadingskip by 10pt \chapbreak }% +  \parsearg\chapheadingzzz +} + +\def\chapheading{\chapbreak \parsearg\chapheadingzzz} +\def\chapheadingzzz#1{% +  \vbox{\chapfonts \raggedtitlesettings #1\par}% +  \nobreak\bigskip \nobreak +  \suppressfirstparagraphindent +} + +% @heading, @subheading, @subsubheading. +\parseargdef\heading{\sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yomitfromtoc}{} +  \suppressfirstparagraphindent} +\parseargdef\subheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{} +  \suppressfirstparagraphindent} +\parseargdef\subsubheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{} +  \suppressfirstparagraphindent} + +% These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only +% (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it), +% given all the information in convenient, parsed form. + +% Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative) +\def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi} + +% Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed) +\newskip\chapheadingskip + +% Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it. +\def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-4000}} +\def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject} +% Because \domark is called before \chapoddpage, the filler page will +% get the headings for the next chapter, which is wrong.  But we don't +% care -- we just disable all headings on the filler page. +\def\chapoddpage{% +  \chappager +  \ifodd\pageno \else +    \begingroup +      \headingsoff +      \null +      \chappager +    \endgroup +  \fi +} + +\def\setchapternewpage #1 {\csname CHAPPAG#1\endcsname} + +\def\CHAPPAGoff{% +\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager +\global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapbreak +\global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager} + +\def\CHAPPAGon{% +\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager +\global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chappager +\global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager +\global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsingle}} + +\def\CHAPPAGodd{% +\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage +\global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapoddpage +\global\let\pagealignmacro=\chapoddpage +\global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}} + +\CHAPPAGon + +% Chapter opening. +% +% #1 is the text, #2 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing, +% Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc), #3 the chapter number. +% +% To test against our argument. +\def\Ynothingkeyword{Ynothing} +\def\Yomitfromtockeyword{Yomitfromtoc} +\def\Yappendixkeyword{Yappendix} +% +\def\chapmacro#1#2#3{% +  % Insert the first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark). +  \let\prevchapterdefs=\lastchapterdefs +  \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs +  \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{}\gdef\thissectionnum{}% +                        \gdef\thissection{}}% +  % +  \def\temptype{#2}% +  \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword +    \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}% +                          \gdef\thischapter{\thischaptername}}% +  \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword +    \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}% +                          \gdef\thischapter{}}% +  \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword +    \toks0={#1}% +    \xdef\lastchapterdefs{% +      \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}% +      \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\appendixletter}% +      % \noexpand\putwordAppendix avoids expanding indigestible +      % commands in some of the translations. +      \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\noexpand\putwordAppendix{} +                                 \noexpand\thischapternum: +                                 \noexpand\thischaptername}% +    }% +  \else +    \toks0={#1}% +    \xdef\lastchapterdefs{% +      \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}% +      \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\the\chapno}% +      % \noexpand\putwordChapter avoids expanding indigestible +      % commands in some of the translations. +      \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\noexpand\putwordChapter{} +                                 \noexpand\thischapternum: +                                 \noexpand\thischaptername}% +    }% +  \fi\fi\fi +  % +  % Output the mark.  Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of +  % the preceding space. +  \safewhatsit\domark +  % +  % Insert the chapter heading break. +  \pchapsepmacro +  % +  % Now the second mark, after the heading break.  No break points +  % between here and the heading. +  \let\prevchapterdefs=\lastchapterdefs +  \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs +  \domark +  % +  {% +    \chapfonts \rmisbold +    % +    % Have to define \lastsection before calling \donoderef, because the +    % xref code eventually uses it.  On the other hand, it has to be called +    % after \pchapsepmacro, or the headline will change too soon. +    \gdef\lastsection{#1}% +    % +    % Only insert the separating space if we have a chapter/appendix +    % number, and don't print the unnumbered ``number''. +    \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword +      \setbox0 = \hbox{}% +      \def\toctype{unnchap}% +    \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword +      \setbox0 = \hbox{}% contents like unnumbered, but no toc entry +      \def\toctype{omit}% +    \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword +      \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} #3\enspace}% +      \def\toctype{app}% +    \else +      \setbox0 = \hbox{#3\enspace}% +      \def\toctype{numchap}% +    \fi\fi\fi +    % +    % Write the toc entry for this chapter.  Must come before the +    % \donoderef, because we include the current node name in the toc +    % entry, and \donoderef resets it to empty. +    \writetocentry{\toctype}{#1}{#3}% +    % +    % For pdftex, we have to write out the node definition (aka, make +    % the pdfdest) after any page break, but before the actual text has +    % been typeset.  If the destination for the pdf outline is after the +    % text, then jumping from the outline may wind up with the text not +    % being visible, for instance under high magnification. +    \donoderef{#2}% +    % +    % Typeset the actual heading. +    \nobreak % Avoid page breaks at the interline glue. +    \vbox{\raggedtitlesettings \hangindent=\wd0 \centerparametersmaybe +          \unhbox0 #1\par}% +  }% +  \nobreak\bigskip % no page break after a chapter title +  \nobreak +} + +% @centerchap -- centered and unnumbered. +\let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax +\def\centerparameters{% +  \advance\rightskip by 3\rightskip +  \leftskip = \rightskip +  \parfillskip = 0pt +} + + +% I don't think this chapter style is supported any more, so I'm not +% updating it with the new noderef stuff.  We'll see.  --karl, 11aug03. +% +\def\setchapterstyle #1 {\csname CHAPF#1\endcsname} +% +\def\unnchfopen #1{% +  \chapoddpage +  \vbox{\chapfonts \raggedtitlesettings #1\par}% +  \nobreak\bigskip\nobreak +} +\def\chfopen #1#2{\chapoddpage {\chapfonts +\vbox to 3in{\vfil \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #2} \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #1} \vfil}}% +\par\penalty 5000 % +} +\def\centerchfopen #1{% +  \chapoddpage +  \vbox{\chapfonts \raggedtitlesettings \hfill #1\hfill}% +  \nobreak\bigskip \nobreak +} +\def\CHAPFopen{% +  \global\let\chapmacro=\chfopen +  \global\let\centerchapmacro=\centerchfopen} + + +% Section titles.  These macros combine the section number parts and +% call the generic \sectionheading to do the printing. +% +\newskip\secheadingskip +\def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip{-1000}} + +% Subsection titles. +\newskip\subsecheadingskip +\def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip{-500}} + +% Subsubsection titles. +\def\subsubsecheadingskip{\subsecheadingskip} +\def\subsubsecheadingbreak{\subsecheadingbreak} + + +% Print any size, any type, section title. +% +% #1 is the text, #2 is the section level (sec/subsec/subsubsec), #3 is +% the section type for xrefs (Ynumbered, Ynothing, Yappendix), #4 is the +% section number. +% +\def\seckeyword{sec} +% +\def\sectionheading#1#2#3#4{% +  {% +    \checkenv{}% should not be in an environment. +    % +    % Switch to the right set of fonts. +    \csname #2fonts\endcsname \rmisbold +    % +    \def\sectionlevel{#2}% +    \def\temptype{#3}% +    % +    % Insert first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark). +    \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs +    \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword +      \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword +        \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{#1}\gdef\thissectionnum{}% +                              \gdef\thissection{\thissectionname}}% +      \fi +    \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword +      % Don't redefine \thissection. +    \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword +      \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword +        \toks0={#1}% +        \xdef\lastsectiondefs{% +          \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}% +          \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}% +          % \noexpand\putwordSection avoids expanding indigestible +          % commands in some of the translations. +          \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\noexpand\putwordSection{} +                                     \noexpand\thissectionnum: +                                     \noexpand\thissectionname}% +        }% +      \fi +    \else +      \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword +        \toks0={#1}% +        \xdef\lastsectiondefs{% +          \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}% +          \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}% +          % \noexpand\putwordSection avoids expanding indigestible +          % commands in some of the translations. +          \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\noexpand\putwordSection{} +                                     \noexpand\thissectionnum: +                                     \noexpand\thissectionname}% +        }% +      \fi +    \fi\fi\fi +    % +    % Go into vertical mode.  Usually we'll already be there, but we +    % don't want the following whatsit to end up in a preceding paragraph +    % if the document didn't happen to have a blank line. +    \par +    % +    % Output the mark.  Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of +    % the preceding space. +    \safewhatsit\domark +    % +    % Insert space above the heading. +    \csname #2headingbreak\endcsname +    % +    % Now the second mark, after the heading break.  No break points +    % between here and the heading. +    \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs +    \domark +    % +    % Only insert the space after the number if we have a section number. +    \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword +      \setbox0 = \hbox{}% +      \def\toctype{unn}% +      \gdef\lastsection{#1}% +    \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword +      % for @headings -- no section number, don't include in toc, +      % and don't redefine \lastsection. +      \setbox0 = \hbox{}% +      \def\toctype{omit}% +      \let\sectionlevel=\empty +    \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword +      \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}% +      \def\toctype{app}% +      \gdef\lastsection{#1}% +    \else +      \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}% +      \def\toctype{num}% +      \gdef\lastsection{#1}% +    \fi\fi\fi +    % +    % Write the toc entry (before \donoderef).  See comments in \chapmacro. +    \writetocentry{\toctype\sectionlevel}{#1}{#4}% +    % +    % Write the node reference (= pdf destination for pdftex). +    % Again, see comments in \chapmacro. +    \donoderef{#3}% +    % +    % Interline glue will be inserted when the vbox is completed. +    % That glue will be a valid breakpoint for the page, since it'll be +    % preceded by a whatsit (usually from the \donoderef, or from the +    % \writetocentry if there was no node).  We don't want to allow that +    % break, since then the whatsits could end up on page n while the +    % section is on page n+1, thus toc/etc. are wrong.  Debian bug 276000. +    \nobreak +    % +    % Output the actual section heading. +    \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \ptexraggedright +          \hangindent=\wd0  % zero if no section number +          \unhbox0 #1}% +  }% +  % Add extra space after the heading -- half of whatever came above it. +  % Don't allow stretch, though. +  \kern .5 \csname #2headingskip\endcsname +  % +  % Do not let the kern be a potential breakpoint, as it would be if it +  % was followed by glue. +  \nobreak +  % +  % We'll almost certainly start a paragraph next, so don't let that +  % glue accumulate.  (Not a breakpoint because it's preceded by a +  % discardable item.)  However, when a paragraph is not started next +  % (\startdefun, \cartouche, \center, etc.), this needs to be wiped out +  % or the negative glue will cause weirdly wrong output, typically +  % obscuring the section heading with something else. +  \vskip-\parskip +  % +  % This is so the last item on the main vertical list is a known +  % \penalty > 10000, so \startdefun, etc., can recognize the situation +  % and do the needful. +  \penalty 10001 +} + + +\message{toc,} +% Table of contents. +\newwrite\tocfile + +% Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary. +% Called from @chapter, etc. +% +% Example usage: \writetocentry{sec}{Section Name}{\the\chapno.\the\secno} +% We append the current node name (if any) and page number as additional +% arguments for the \{chap,sec,...}entry macros which will eventually +% read this.  The node name is used in the pdf outlines as the +% destination to jump to. +% +% We open the .toc file for writing here instead of at @setfilename (or +% any other fixed time) so that @contents can be anywhere in the document. +% But if #1 is `omit', then we don't do anything.  This is used for the +% table of contents chapter openings themselves. +% +\newif\iftocfileopened +\def\omitkeyword{omit}% +% +\def\writetocentry#1#2#3{% +  \edef\writetoctype{#1}% +  \ifx\writetoctype\omitkeyword \else +    \iftocfileopened\else +      \immediate\openout\tocfile = \jobname.toc +      \global\tocfileopenedtrue +    \fi +    % +    \iflinks +      {\atdummies +       \edef\temp{% +         \write\tocfile{@#1entry{#2}{#3}{\lastnode}{\noexpand\folio}}}% +       \temp +      }% +    \fi +  \fi +  % +  % Tell \shipout to create a pdf destination on each page, if we're +  % writing pdf.  These are used in the table of contents.  We can't +  % just write one on every page because the title pages are numbered +  % 1 and 2 (the page numbers aren't printed), and so are the first +  % two pages of the document.  Thus, we'd have two destinations named +  % `1', and two named `2'. +  \ifpdf \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue \fi +} + + +% These characters do not print properly in the Computer Modern roman +% fonts, so we must take special care.  This is more or less redundant +% with the Texinfo input format setup at the end of this file. +% +\def\activecatcodes{% +  \catcode`\"=\active +  \catcode`\$=\active +  \catcode`\<=\active +  \catcode`\>=\active +  \catcode`\\=\active +  \catcode`\^=\active +  \catcode`\_=\active +  \catcode`\|=\active +  \catcode`\~=\active +} + + +% Read the toc file, which is essentially Texinfo input. +\def\readtocfile{% +  \setupdatafile +  \activecatcodes +  \input \tocreadfilename +} + +\newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=1in +\newcount\savepageno +\newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -1 + +% Prepare to read what we've written to \tocfile. +% +\def\startcontents#1{% +  % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should +  % start on an odd page, unlike chapters.  Thus, we maintain +  % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro. +  % From: Torbjorn Granlund <[email protected]> +  \contentsalignmacro +  \immediate\closeout\tocfile +  % +  % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline. +  % It is abundantly clear what they are. +  \chapmacro{#1}{Yomitfromtoc}{}% +  % +  \savepageno = \pageno +  \begingroup                  % Set up to handle contents files properly. +    \raggedbottom              % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom. +    \advance\hsize by -\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length. +    % +    % Roman numerals for page numbers. +    \ifnum \pageno>0 \global\pageno = \lastnegativepageno \fi +} + +% redefined for the two-volume lispref.  We always output on +% \jobname.toc even if this is redefined. +% +\def\tocreadfilename{\jobname.toc} + +% Normal (long) toc. +% +\def\contents{% +  \startcontents{\putwordTOC}% +    \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space +    \ifeof 1 \else +      \readtocfile +    \fi +    \vfill \eject +    \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect +    \ifeof 1 \else +      \pdfmakeoutlines +    \fi +    \closein 1 +  \endgroup +  \lastnegativepageno = \pageno +  \global\pageno = \savepageno +} + +% And just the chapters. +\def\summarycontents{% +  \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}% +    % +    \let\partentry = \shortpartentry +    \let\numchapentry = \shortchapentry +    \let\appentry = \shortchapentry +    \let\unnchapentry = \shortunnchapentry +    % We want a true roman here for the page numbers. +    \secfonts +    \let\rm=\shortcontrm \let\bf=\shortcontbf +    \let\sl=\shortcontsl \let\tt=\shortconttt +    \rm +    \hyphenpenalty = 10000 +    \advance\baselineskip by 1pt % Open it up a little. +    \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{} +    \let\appsecentry = \numsecentry +    \let\unnsecentry = \numsecentry +    \let\numsubsecentry = \numsecentry +    \let\appsubsecentry = \numsecentry +    \let\unnsubsecentry = \numsecentry +    \let\numsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry +    \let\appsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry +    \let\unnsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry +    \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space +    \ifeof 1 \else +      \readtocfile +    \fi +    \closein 1 +    \vfill \eject +    \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect +  \endgroup +  \lastnegativepageno = \pageno +  \global\pageno = \savepageno +} +\let\shortcontents = \summarycontents + +% Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents. +% The arg is, e.g., `A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter. +% +\def\shortchaplabel#1{% +  % This space should be enough, since a single number is .5em, and the +  % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts. +  % But use \hss just in case. +  % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after +  % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.) +  % +  % We'd like to right-justify chapter numbers, but that looks strange +  % with appendix letters.  And right-justifying numbers and +  % left-justifying letters looks strange when there is less than 10 +  % chapters.  Have to read the whole toc once to know how many chapters +  % there are before deciding ... +  \hbox to 1em{#1\hss}% +} + +% These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents. +% The first argument is the chapter or section name. +% The last argument is the page number. +% The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ... + +% Parts, in the main contents.  Replace the part number, which doesn't +% exist, with an empty box.  Let's hope all the numbers have the same width. +% Also ignore the page number, which is conventionally not printed. +\def\numeralbox{\setbox0=\hbox{8}\hbox to \wd0{\hfil}} +\def\partentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\numeralbox\labelspace#1}{}} +% +% Parts, in the short toc. +\def\shortpartentry#1#2#3#4{% +  \penalty-300 +  \vskip.5\baselineskip plus.15\baselineskip minus.1\baselineskip +  \shortchapentry{{\bf #1}}{\numeralbox}{}{}% +} + +% Chapters, in the main contents. +\def\numchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}} +% +% Chapters, in the short toc. +% See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings. +\def\shortchapentry#1#2#3#4{% +  \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}% +} + +% Appendices, in the main contents. +% Need the word Appendix, and a fixed-size box. +% +\def\appendixbox#1{% +  % We use M since it's probably the widest letter. +  \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} M}% +  \hbox to \wd0{\putwordAppendix{} #1\hss}} +% +\def\appentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\appendixbox{#2}\labelspace#1}{#4}} + +% Unnumbered chapters. +\def\unnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#1}{#4}} +\def\shortunnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}} + +% Sections. +\def\numsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}} +\let\appsecentry=\numsecentry +\def\unnsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#1}{#4}} + +% Subsections. +\def\numsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}} +\let\appsubsecentry=\numsubsecentry +\def\unnsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#4}} + +% And subsubsections. +\def\numsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}} +\let\appsubsubsecentry=\numsubsubsecentry +\def\unnsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#4}} + +% This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels. +% Same as \defaultparindent. +\newdimen\tocindent \tocindent = 15pt + +% Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the +% page number. +% +% If the toc has to be broken over pages, we want it to be at chapters +% if at all possible; hence the \penalty. +\def\dochapentry#1#2{% +   \penalty-300 \vskip1\baselineskip plus.33\baselineskip minus.25\baselineskip +   \begingroup +     \chapentryfonts +     \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% +   \endgroup +   \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip plus.1\baselineskip +} + +\def\dosecentry#1#2{\begingroup +  \secentryfonts \leftskip=\tocindent +  \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% +\endgroup} + +\def\dosubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup +  \subsecentryfonts \leftskip=2\tocindent +  \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% +\endgroup} + +\def\dosubsubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup +  \subsubsecentryfonts \leftskip=3\tocindent +  \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% +\endgroup} + +% We use the same \entry macro as for the index entries. +\let\tocentry = \entry + +% Space between chapter (or whatever) number and the title. +\def\labelspace{\hskip1em \relax} + +\def\dopageno#1{{\rm #1}} +\def\doshortpageno#1{{\rm #1}} + +\def\chapentryfonts{\secfonts \rm} +\def\secentryfonts{\textfonts} +\def\subsecentryfonts{\textfonts} +\def\subsubsecentryfonts{\textfonts} + + +\message{environments,} +% @foo ... @end foo. + +% @tex ... @end tex    escapes into raw TeX temporarily. +% One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works. +% But \@ or @@ will get a plain @ character. + +\envdef\tex{% +  \setupmarkupstyle{tex}% +  \catcode `\\=0 \catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2 +  \catcode `\$=3 \catcode `\&=4 \catcode `\#=6 +  \catcode `\^=7 \catcode `\_=8 \catcode `\~=\active \let~=\tie +  \catcode `\%=14 +  \catcode `\+=\other +  \catcode `\"=\other +  \catcode `\|=\other +  \catcode `\<=\other +  \catcode `\>=\other +  \catcode`\`=\other +  \catcode`\'=\other +  \escapechar=`\\ +  % +  % ' is active in math mode (mathcode"8000).  So reset it, and all our +  % other math active characters (just in case), to plain's definitions. +  \mathactive +  % +  \let\b=\ptexb +  \let\bullet=\ptexbullet +  \let\c=\ptexc +  \let\,=\ptexcomma +  \let\.=\ptexdot +  \let\dots=\ptexdots +  \let\equiv=\ptexequiv +  \let\!=\ptexexclam +  \let\i=\ptexi +  \let\indent=\ptexindent +  \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent +  \let\{=\ptexlbrace +  \let\+=\tabalign +  \let\}=\ptexrbrace +  \let\/=\ptexslash +  \let\*=\ptexstar +  \let\t=\ptext +  \expandafter \let\csname top\endcsname=\ptextop  % outer +  \let\frenchspacing=\plainfrenchspacing +  % +  \def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}% +  \def\enddots{\relax\ifmmode\endldots\else$\mathsurround=0pt \endldots\,$\fi}% +  \def\@{@}% +} +% There is no need to define \Etex. + +% Define @lisp ... @end lisp. +% @lisp environment forms a group so it can rebind things, +% including the definition of @end lisp (which normally is erroneous). + +% Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp. +\newskip\lispnarrowing \lispnarrowing=0.4in + +% This is the definition that ^^M gets inside @lisp, @example, and other +% such environments.  \null is better than a space, since it doesn't +% have any width. +\def\lisppar{\null\endgraf} + +% This space is always present above and below environments. +\newskip\envskipamount \envskipamount = 0pt + +% Make spacing and below environment symmetrical.  We use \parskip here +% to help in doing that, since in @example-like environments \parskip +% is reset to zero; thus the \afterenvbreak inserts no space -- but the +% start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip. +% +\def\aboveenvbreak{{% +  % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and +  % \sectionheading, q.v. +  \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else +    \advance\envskipamount by \parskip +    \endgraf +    \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount +      \removelastskip +      % it's not a good place to break if the last penalty was \nobreak +      % or better ... +      \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \penalty-50 \fi +      \vskip\envskipamount +    \fi +  \fi +}} + +\let\afterenvbreak = \aboveenvbreak + +% \nonarrowing is a flag.  If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins; it will +% also clear it, so that its embedded environments do the narrowing again. +\let\nonarrowing=\relax + +% @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around +% environment contents. +\font\circle=lcircle10 +\newdimen\circthick +\newdimen\cartouter\newdimen\cartinner +\newskip\normbskip\newskip\normpskip\newskip\normlskip +\circthick=\fontdimen8\circle +% +\def\ctl{{\circle\char'013\hskip -6pt}}% 6pt from pl file: 1/2charwidth +\def\ctr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'010}} +\def\cbl{{\circle\char'012\hskip -6pt}} +\def\cbr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'011}} +\def\carttop{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip +        \ctl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\ctr +        \hskip\rskip}} +\def\cartbot{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip +        \cbl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\cbr +        \hskip\rskip}} +% +\newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip + +\envdef\cartouche{% +  \ifhmode\par\fi  % can't be in the midst of a paragraph. +  \startsavinginserts +  \lskip=\leftskip \rskip=\rightskip +  \leftskip=0pt\rightskip=0pt % we want these *outside*. +  \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip +  \advance\cartinner by-\rskip +  \cartouter=\hsize +  \advance\cartouter by 18.4pt	% allow for 3pt kerns on either +				% side, and for 6pt waste from +				% each corner char, and rule thickness +  \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip +  % Flag to tell @lisp, etc., not to narrow margin. +  \let\nonarrowing = t% +  % +  % If this cartouche directly follows a sectioning command, we need the +  % \parskip glue (backspaced over by default) or the cartouche can +  % collide with the section heading. +  \ifnum\lastpenalty>10000 \vskip\parskip \penalty\lastpenalty \fi +  % +  \vbox\bgroup +      \baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt +      \carttop +      \hbox\bgroup +	  \hskip\lskip +	  \vrule\kern3pt +	  \vbox\bgroup +	      \kern3pt +	      \hsize=\cartinner +	      \baselineskip=\normbskip +	      \lineskip=\normlskip +	      \parskip=\normpskip +	      \vskip -\parskip +	      \comment % For explanation, see the end of def\group. +} +\def\Ecartouche{% +              \ifhmode\par\fi +	      \kern3pt +	  \egroup +	  \kern3pt\vrule +	  \hskip\rskip +      \egroup +      \cartbot +  \egroup +  \checkinserts +} + + +% This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants, +% inside a group. +\newdimen\nonfillparindent +\def\nonfillstart{% +  \aboveenvbreak +  \hfuzz = 12pt % Don't be fussy +  \sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens. +  \let\par = \lisppar % don't ignore blank lines +  \obeylines % each line of input is a line of output +  \parskip = 0pt +  % Turn off paragraph indentation but redefine \indent to emulate +  % the normal \indent. +  \nonfillparindent=\parindent +  \parindent = 0pt +  \let\indent\nonfillindent +  % +  \emergencystretch = 0pt % don't try to avoid overfull boxes +  \ifx\nonarrowing\relax +    \advance \leftskip by \lispnarrowing +    \exdentamount=\lispnarrowing +  \else +    \let\nonarrowing = \relax +  \fi +  \let\exdent=\nofillexdent +} + +\begingroup +\obeyspaces +% We want to swallow spaces (but not other tokens) after the fake +% @indent in our nonfill-environments, where spaces are normally +% active and set to @tie, resulting in them not being ignored after +% @indent. +\gdef\nonfillindent{\futurelet\temp\nonfillindentcheck}% +\gdef\nonfillindentcheck{% +\ifx\temp % +\expandafter\nonfillindentgobble% +\else% +\leavevmode\nonfillindentbox% +\fi% +}% +\endgroup +\def\nonfillindentgobble#1{\nonfillindent} +\def\nonfillindentbox{\hbox to \nonfillparindent{\hss}} + +% If you want all examples etc. small: @set dispenvsize small. +% If you want even small examples the full size: @set dispenvsize nosmall. +% This affects the following displayed environments: +%    @example, @display, @format, @lisp +% +\def\smallword{small} +\def\nosmallword{nosmall} +\let\SETdispenvsize\relax +\def\setnormaldispenv{% +  \ifx\SETdispenvsize\smallword +    % end paragraph for sake of leading, in case document has no blank +    % line.  This is redundant with what happens in \aboveenvbreak, but +    % we need to do it before changing the fonts, and it's inconvenient +    % to change the fonts afterward. +    \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi +    \smallexamplefonts \rm +  \fi +} +\def\setsmalldispenv{% +  \ifx\SETdispenvsize\nosmallword +  \else +    \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi +    \smallexamplefonts \rm +  \fi +} + +% We often define two environments, @foo and @smallfoo. +% Let's do it in one command.  #1 is the env name, #2 the definition. +\def\makedispenvdef#1#2{% +  \expandafter\envdef\csname#1\endcsname {\setnormaldispenv #2}% +  \expandafter\envdef\csname small#1\endcsname {\setsmalldispenv #2}% +  \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak +  \expandafter\let\csname Esmall#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak +} + +% Define two environment synonyms (#1 and #2) for an environment. +\def\maketwodispenvdef#1#2#3{% +  \makedispenvdef{#1}{#3}% +  \makedispenvdef{#2}{#3}% +} +% +% @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font; +% @example: same as @lisp. +% +% @smallexample and @smalllisp: use smaller fonts. +% Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox. +% +\maketwodispenvdef{lisp}{example}{% +  \nonfillstart +  \tt\setupmarkupstyle{example}% +  \let\kbdfont = \kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special. +  \gobble % eat return +} +% @display/@smalldisplay: same as @lisp except keep current font. +% +\makedispenvdef{display}{% +  \nonfillstart +  \gobble +} + +% @format/@smallformat: same as @display except don't narrow margins. +% +\makedispenvdef{format}{% +  \let\nonarrowing = t% +  \nonfillstart +  \gobble +} + +% @flushleft: same as @format, but doesn't obey \SETdispenvsize. +\envdef\flushleft{% +  \let\nonarrowing = t% +  \nonfillstart +  \gobble +} +\let\Eflushleft = \afterenvbreak + +% @flushright. +% +\envdef\flushright{% +  \let\nonarrowing = t% +  \nonfillstart +  \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill\relax +  \gobble +} +\let\Eflushright = \afterenvbreak + + +% @raggedright does more-or-less normal line breaking but no right +% justification.  From plain.tex. +\envdef\raggedright{% +  \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax +} +\let\Eraggedright\par + +\envdef\raggedleft{% +  \parindent=0pt \leftskip0pt plus2em +  \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em \parfillskip=0pt +  \hbadness=10000 % Last line will usually be underfull, so turn off +                  % badness reporting. +} +\let\Eraggedleft\par + +\envdef\raggedcenter{% +  \parindent=0pt \rightskip0pt plus1em \leftskip0pt plus1em +  \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em \parfillskip=0pt +  \hbadness=10000 % Last line will usually be underfull, so turn off +                  % badness reporting. +} +\let\Eraggedcenter\par + + +% @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart) +% and narrows the margins.  We keep \parskip nonzero in general, since +% we're doing normal filling.  So, when using \aboveenvbreak and +% \afterenvbreak, temporarily make \parskip 0. +% +\makedispenvdef{quotation}{\quotationstart} +% +\def\quotationstart{% +  \indentedblockstart % same as \indentedblock, but increase right margin too. +  \ifx\nonarrowing\relax +    \advance\rightskip by \lispnarrowing +  \fi +  \parsearg\quotationlabel +} + +% We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're +% doing normal filling. +% +\def\Equotation{% +  \par +  \ifx\quotationauthor\thisisundefined\else +    % indent a bit. +    \leftline{\kern 2\leftskip \sl ---\quotationauthor}% +  \fi +  {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}% +} +\def\Esmallquotation{\Equotation} + +% If we're given an argument, typeset it in bold with a colon after. +\def\quotationlabel#1{% +  \def\temp{#1}% +  \ifx\temp\empty \else +    {\bf #1: }% +  \fi +} + +% @indentedblock is like @quotation, but indents only on the left and +% has no optional argument. +% +\makedispenvdef{indentedblock}{\indentedblockstart} +% +\def\indentedblockstart{% +  {\parskip=0pt \aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip +  \parindent=0pt +  % +  % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down. +  \ifx\nonarrowing\relax +    \advance\leftskip by \lispnarrowing +    \exdentamount = \lispnarrowing +  \else +    \let\nonarrowing = \relax +  \fi +} + +% Keep a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're doing normal filling. +% +\def\Eindentedblock{% +  \par +  {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}% +} +\def\Esmallindentedblock{\Eindentedblock} + + +% LaTeX-like @verbatim...@end verbatim and @verb{<char>...<char>} +% If we want to allow any <char> as delimiter, +% we need the curly braces so that makeinfo sees the @verb command, eg: +% `@verbx...x' would look like the '@verbx' command.  [email protected] +% +% [Knuth]: Donald Ervin Knuth, 1996.  The TeXbook. +% +% [Knuth] p.344; only we need to do the other characters Texinfo sets +% active too.  Otherwise, they get lost as the first character on a +% verbatim line. +\def\dospecials{% +  \do\ \do\\\do\{\do\}\do\$\do\&% +  \do\#\do\^\do\^^K\do\_\do\^^A\do\%\do\~% +  \do\<\do\>\do\|\do\@\do+\do\"% +  % Don't do the quotes -- if we do, @set txicodequoteundirected and +  % @set txicodequotebacktick will not have effect on @verb and +  % @verbatim, and ?` and !` ligatures won't get disabled. +  %\do\`\do\'% +} +% +% [Knuth] p. 380 +\def\uncatcodespecials{% +  \def\do##1{\catcode`##1=\other}\dospecials} +% +% Setup for the @verb command. +% +% Eight spaces for a tab +\begingroup +  \catcode`\^^I=\active +  \gdef\tabeightspaces{\catcode`\^^I=\active\def^^I{\ \ \ \ \ \ \ \ }} +\endgroup +% +\def\setupverb{% +  \tt  % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim +  \def\par{\leavevmode\endgraf}% +  \setupmarkupstyle{verb}% +  \tabeightspaces +  % Respect line breaks, +  % print special symbols as themselves, and +  % make each space count +  % must do in this order: +  \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces +} + +% Setup for the @verbatim environment +% +% Real tab expansion. +\newdimen\tabw \setbox0=\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=8\wd0 % tab amount +% +% We typeset each line of the verbatim in an \hbox, so we can handle +% tabs.  The \global is in case the verbatim line starts with an accent, +% or some other command that starts with a begin-group.  Otherwise, the +% entire \verbbox would disappear at the corresponding end-group, before +% it is typeset.  Meanwhile, we can't have nested verbatim commands +% (can we?), so the \global won't be overwriting itself. +\newbox\verbbox +\def\starttabbox{\global\setbox\verbbox=\hbox\bgroup} +% +\begingroup +  \catcode`\^^I=\active +  \gdef\tabexpand{% +    \catcode`\^^I=\active +    \def^^I{\leavevmode\egroup +      \dimen\verbbox=\wd\verbbox % the width so far, or since the previous tab +      \divide\dimen\verbbox by\tabw +      \multiply\dimen\verbbox by\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw +      \advance\dimen\verbbox by\tabw  % advance to next multiple of \tabw +      \wd\verbbox=\dimen\verbbox \box\verbbox \starttabbox +    }% +  } +\endgroup + +% start the verbatim environment. +\def\setupverbatim{% +  \let\nonarrowing = t% +  \nonfillstart +  \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim +  % The \leavevmode here is for blank lines.  Otherwise, we would +  % never \starttabox and the \egroup would end verbatim mode. +  \def\par{\leavevmode\egroup\box\verbbox\endgraf}% +  \tabexpand +  \setupmarkupstyle{verbatim}% +  % Respect line breaks, +  % print special symbols as themselves, and +  % make each space count. +  % Must do in this order: +  \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces +  \everypar{\starttabbox}% +} + +% Do the @verb magic: verbatim text is quoted by unique +% delimiter characters.  Before first delimiter expect a +% right brace, after last delimiter expect closing brace: +% +%    \def\doverb'{'<char>#1<char>'}'{#1} +% +% [Knuth] p. 382; only eat outer {} +\begingroup +  \catcode`[=1\catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=\other\catcode`\}=\other +  \gdef\doverb{#1[\def\next##1#1}[##1\endgroup]\next] +\endgroup +% +\def\verb{\begingroup\setupverb\doverb} +% +% +% Do the @verbatim magic: define the macro \doverbatim so that +% the (first) argument ends when '@end verbatim' is reached, ie: +% +%     \def\doverbatim#1@end verbatim{#1} +% +% For Texinfo it's a lot easier than for LaTeX, +% because texinfo's \verbatim doesn't stop at '\end{verbatim}': +% we need not redefine '\', '{' and '}'. +% +% Inspired by LaTeX's verbatim command set [latex.ltx] +% +\begingroup +  \catcode`\ =\active +  \obeylines % +  % ignore everything up to the first ^^M, that's the newline at the end +  % of the @verbatim input line itself.  Otherwise we get an extra blank +  % line in the output. +  \xdef\doverbatim#1^^M#2@end verbatim{#2\noexpand\end\gobble verbatim}% +  % We really want {...\end verbatim} in the body of the macro, but +  % without the active space; thus we have to use \xdef and \gobble. +\endgroup +% +\envdef\verbatim{% +    \setupverbatim\doverbatim +} +\let\Everbatim = \afterenvbreak + + +% @verbatiminclude FILE - insert text of file in verbatim environment. +% +\def\verbatiminclude{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\doverbatiminclude} +% +\def\doverbatiminclude#1{% +  {% +    \makevalueexpandable +    \setupverbatim +    \indexnofonts       % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names. +    \wlog{texinfo.tex: doing @verbatiminclude of #1^^J}% +    \input #1 +    \afterenvbreak +  }% +} + +% @copying ... @end copying. +% Save the text away for @insertcopying later. +% +% We save the uninterpreted tokens, rather than creating a box. +% Saving the text in a box would be much easier, but then all the +% typesetting commands (@smallbook, font changes, etc.) have to be done +% beforehand -- and a) we want @copying to be done first in the source +% file; b) letting users define the frontmatter in as flexible order as +% possible is very desirable. +% +\def\copying{\checkenv{}\begingroup\scanargctxt\docopying} +\def\docopying#1@end copying{\endgroup\def\copyingtext{#1}} +% +\def\insertcopying{% +  \begingroup +    \parindent = 0pt  % paragraph indentation looks wrong on title page +    \scanexp\copyingtext +  \endgroup +} + + +\message{defuns,} +% @defun etc. + +\newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=.4in +\newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=50pt +\newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=18pt +\newcount\defunpenalty + +% Start the processing of @deffn: +\def\startdefun{% +  \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 +    \medbreak +    \defunpenalty=10003 % Will keep this @deffn together with the +                        % following @def command, see below. +  \else +    % If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak, +    % which is there to keep the function description together with its +    % header.  But if there's nothing but headers, we need to allow a +    % break somewhere.  Check specifically for penalty 10002, inserted +    % by \printdefunline, instead of 10000, since the sectioning +    % commands also insert a nobreak penalty, and we don't want to allow +    % a break between a section heading and a defun. +    % +    % As a further refinement, we avoid "club" headers by signalling +    % with penalty of 10003 after the very first @deffn in the +    % sequence (see above), and penalty of 10002 after any following +    % @def command. +    \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty2000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi +    % +    % Similarly, after a section heading, do not allow a break. +    % But do insert the glue. +    \medskip  % preceded by discardable penalty, so not a breakpoint +  \fi +  % +  \parindent=0in +  \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent +  \exdentamount=\defbodyindent +} + +\def\dodefunx#1{% +  % First, check whether we are in the right environment: +  \checkenv#1% +  % +  % As above, allow line break if we have multiple x headers in a row. +  % It's not a great place, though. +  \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty3000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi +  % +  % And now, it's time to reuse the body of the original defun: +  \expandafter\gobbledefun#1% +} +\def\gobbledefun#1\startdefun{} + +% \printdefunline \deffnheader{text} +% +\def\printdefunline#1#2{% +  \begingroup +    % call \deffnheader: +    #1#2 \endheader +    % common ending: +    \interlinepenalty = 10000 +    \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil\relax +    \endgraf +    \nobreak\vskip -\parskip +    \penalty\defunpenalty  % signal to \startdefun and \dodefunx +    % Some of the @defun-type tags do not enable magic parentheses, +    % rendering the following check redundant.  But we don't optimize. +    \checkparencounts +  \endgroup +} + +\def\Edefun{\endgraf\medbreak} + +% \makedefun{deffn} creates \deffn, \deffnx and \Edeffn; +% the only thing remaining is to define \deffnheader. +% +\def\makedefun#1{% +  \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname = \Edefun +  \edef\temp{\noexpand\domakedefun +    \makecsname{#1}\makecsname{#1x}\makecsname{#1header}}% +  \temp +} + +% \domakedefun \deffn \deffnx \deffnheader +% +% Define \deffn and \deffnx, without parameters. +% \deffnheader has to be defined explicitly. +% +\def\domakedefun#1#2#3{% +  \envdef#1{% +    \startdefun +    \doingtypefnfalse    % distinguish typed functions from all else +    \parseargusing\activeparens{\printdefunline#3}% +  }% +  \def#2{\dodefunx#1}% +  \def#3% +} + +\newif\ifdoingtypefn       % doing typed function? +\newif\ifrettypeownline    % typeset return type on its own line? + +% @deftypefnnewline on|off says whether the return type of typed functions +% are printed on their own line.  This affects @deftypefn, @deftypefun, +% @deftypeop, and @deftypemethod. +% +\parseargdef\deftypefnnewline{% +  \def\temp{#1}% +  \ifx\temp\onword +    \expandafter\let\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname +      = \empty +  \else\ifx\temp\offword +    \expandafter\let\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname +      = \relax +  \else +    \errhelp = \EMsimple +    \errmessage{Unknown @txideftypefnnl value `\temp', +                must be on|off}% +  \fi\fi +} + +% Untyped functions: + +% @deffn category name args +\makedefun{deffn}{\deffngeneral{}} + +% @deffn category class name args +\makedefun{defop}#1 {\defopon{#1\ \putwordon}} + +% \defopon {category on}class name args +\def\defopon#1#2 {\deffngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} } + +% \deffngeneral {subind}category name args +% +\def\deffngeneral#1#2 #3 #4\endheader{% +  % Remember that \dosubind{fn}{foo}{} is equivalent to \doind{fn}{foo}. +  \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{#1}% +  \defname{#2}{}{#3}\magicamp\defunargs{#4\unskip}% +} + +% Typed functions: + +% @deftypefn category type name args +\makedefun{deftypefn}{\deftypefngeneral{}} + +% @deftypeop category class type name args +\makedefun{deftypeop}#1 {\deftypeopon{#1\ \putwordon}} + +% \deftypeopon {category on}class type name args +\def\deftypeopon#1#2 {\deftypefngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} } + +% \deftypefngeneral {subind}category type name args +% +\def\deftypefngeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{% +  \dosubind{fn}{\code{#4}}{#1}% +  \doingtypefntrue +  \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}% +} + +% Typed variables: + +% @deftypevr category type var args +\makedefun{deftypevr}{\deftypecvgeneral{}} + +% @deftypecv category class type var args +\makedefun{deftypecv}#1 {\deftypecvof{#1\ \putwordof}} + +% \deftypecvof {category of}class type var args +\def\deftypecvof#1#2 {\deftypecvgeneral{\putwordof\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} } + +% \deftypecvgeneral {subind}category type var args +% +\def\deftypecvgeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{% +  \dosubind{vr}{\code{#4}}{#1}% +  \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}% +} + +% Untyped variables: + +% @defvr category var args +\makedefun{defvr}#1 {\deftypevrheader{#1} {} } + +% @defcv category class var args +\makedefun{defcv}#1 {\defcvof{#1\ \putwordof}} + +% \defcvof {category of}class var args +\def\defcvof#1#2 {\deftypecvof{#1}#2 {} } + +% Types: + +% @deftp category name args +\makedefun{deftp}#1 #2 #3\endheader{% +  \doind{tp}{\code{#2}}% +  \defname{#1}{}{#2}\defunargs{#3\unskip}% +} + +% Remaining @defun-like shortcuts: +\makedefun{defun}{\deffnheader{\putwordDeffunc} } +\makedefun{defmac}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefmac} } +\makedefun{defspec}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefspec} } +\makedefun{deftypefun}{\deftypefnheader{\putwordDeffunc} } +\makedefun{defvar}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefvar} } +\makedefun{defopt}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefopt} } +\makedefun{deftypevar}{\deftypevrheader{\putwordDefvar} } +\makedefun{defmethod}{\defopon\putwordMethodon} +\makedefun{deftypemethod}{\deftypeopon\putwordMethodon} +\makedefun{defivar}{\defcvof\putwordInstanceVariableof} +\makedefun{deftypeivar}{\deftypecvof\putwordInstanceVariableof} + +% \defname, which formats the name of the @def (not the args). +% #1 is the category, such as "Function". +% #2 is the return type, if any. +% #3 is the function name. +% +% We are followed by (but not passed) the arguments, if any. +% +\def\defname#1#2#3{% +  \par +  % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def... +  \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent +  % +  % Determine if we are typesetting the return type of a typed function +  % on a line by itself. +  \rettypeownlinefalse +  \ifdoingtypefn  % doing a typed function specifically? +    % then check user option for putting return type on its own line: +    \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname\relax \else +      \rettypeownlinetrue +    \fi +  \fi +  % +  % How we'll format the category name.  Putting it in brackets helps +  % distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line +  % just below it. +  \def\temp{#1}% +  \setbox0=\hbox{\kern\deflastargmargin \ifx\temp\empty\else [\rm\temp]\fi} +  % +  % Figure out line sizes for the paragraph shape.  We'll always have at +  % least two. +  \tempnum = 2 +  % +  % The first line needs space for \box0; but if \rightskip is nonzero, +  % we need only space for the part of \box0 which exceeds it: +  \dimen0=\hsize  \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0  \advance\dimen0 by \rightskip +  % +  % If doing a return type on its own line, we'll have another line. +  \ifrettypeownline +    \advance\tempnum by 1 +    \def\maybeshapeline{0in \hsize}% +  \else +    \def\maybeshapeline{}% +  \fi +  % +  % The continuations: +  \dimen2=\hsize  \advance\dimen2 by -\defargsindent +  % +  % The final paragraph shape: +  \parshape \tempnum  0in \dimen0  \maybeshapeline  \defargsindent \dimen2 +  % +  % Put the category name at the right margin. +  \noindent +  \hbox to 0pt{% +    \hfil\box0 \kern-\hsize +    % \hsize has to be shortened this way: +    \kern\leftskip +    % Intentionally do not respect \rightskip, since we need the space. +  }% +  % +  % Allow all lines to be underfull without complaint: +  \tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000 +  \exdentamount=\defbodyindent +  {% +    % defun fonts. We use typewriter by default (used to be bold) because: +    % . we're printing identifiers, they should be in tt in principle. +    % . in languages with many accents, such as Czech or French, it's +    %   common to leave accents off identifiers.  The result looks ok in +    %   tt, but exceedingly strange in rm. +    % . we don't want -- and --- to be treated as ligatures. +    % . this still does not fix the ?` and !` ligatures, but so far no +    %   one has made identifiers using them :). +    \df \tt +    \def\temp{#2}% text of the return type +    \ifx\temp\empty\else +      \tclose{\temp}% typeset the return type +      \ifrettypeownline +        % put return type on its own line; prohibit line break following: +        \hfil\vadjust{\nobreak}\break +      \else +        \space  % type on same line, so just followed by a space +      \fi +    \fi           % no return type +    #3% output function name +  }% +  {\rm\enskip}% hskip 0.5 em of \tenrm +  % +  \boldbrax +  % arguments will be output next, if any. +} + +% Print arguments in slanted roman (not ttsl), inconsistently with using +% tt for the name.  This is because literal text is sometimes needed in +% the argument list (groff manual), and ttsl and tt are not very +% distinguishable.  Prevent hyphenation at `-' chars. +% +\def\defunargs#1{% +  % use sl by default (not ttsl), +  % tt for the names. +  \df \sl \hyphenchar\font=0 +  % +  % On the other hand, if an argument has two dashes (for instance), we +  % want a way to get ttsl.  We used to recommend @var for that, so +  % leave the code in, but it's strange for @var to lead to typewriter. +  % Nowadays we recommend @code, since the difference between a ttsl hyphen +  % and a tt hyphen is pretty tiny.  @code also disables ?` !`. +  \def\var##1{{\setupmarkupstyle{var}\ttslanted{##1}}}% +  #1% +  \sl\hyphenchar\font=45 +} + +% We want ()&[] to print specially on the defun line. +% +\def\activeparens{% +  \catcode`\(=\active \catcode`\)=\active +  \catcode`\[=\active \catcode`\]=\active +  \catcode`\&=\active +} + +% Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars. +\let\lparen = ( \let\rparen = ) + +% Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc.  For example, +% if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet, +% so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence. +{ +  \activeparens +  \global\let(=\lparen \global\let)=\rparen +  \global\let[=\lbrack \global\let]=\rbrack +  \global\let& = \& + +  \gdef\boldbrax{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb} +  \gdef\magicamp{\let&=\amprm} +} + +\newcount\parencount + +% If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards +\newif\ifampseen +\def\amprm#1 {\ampseentrue{\bf\ }} + +\def\parenfont{% +  \ifampseen +    % At the first level, print parens in roman, +    % otherwise use the default font. +    \ifnum \parencount=1 \rm \fi +  \else +    % The \sf parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than +    % the contained text.  This is especially needed for [ and ] . +    \sf +  \fi +} +\def\infirstlevel#1{% +  \ifampseen +    \ifnum\parencount=1 +      #1% +    \fi +  \fi +} +\def\bfafterword#1 {#1 \bf} + +\def\opnr{% +  \global\advance\parencount by 1 +  {\parenfont(}% +  \infirstlevel \bfafterword +} +\def\clnr{% +  {\parenfont)}% +  \infirstlevel \sl +  \global\advance\parencount by -1 +} + +\newcount\brackcount +\def\lbrb{% +  \global\advance\brackcount by 1 +  {\bf[}% +} +\def\rbrb{% +  {\bf]}% +  \global\advance\brackcount by -1 +} + +\def\checkparencounts{% +  \ifnum\parencount=0 \else \badparencount \fi +  \ifnum\brackcount=0 \else \badbrackcount \fi +} +% these should not use \errmessage; the glibc manual, at least, actually +% has such constructs (when documenting function pointers). +\def\badparencount{% +  \message{Warning: unbalanced parentheses in @def...}% +  \global\parencount=0 +} +\def\badbrackcount{% +  \message{Warning: unbalanced square brackets in @def...}% +  \global\brackcount=0 +} + + +\message{macros,} +% @macro. + +% To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens, +% which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX. +\ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined +  \newwrite\macscribble +  \def\scantokens#1{% +    \toks0={#1}% +    \immediate\openout\macscribble=\jobname.tmp +    \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}% +    \immediate\closeout\macscribble +    \input \jobname.tmp +  } +\fi + +\def\scanmacro#1{\begingroup +  \newlinechar`\^^M +  \let\xeatspaces\eatspaces +  % +  % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex +  % When called from @insertcopying or (short)caption, we need active +  % backslash to get it printed correctly.  Previously, we had +  % \catcode`\\=\other instead.  We'll see whether a problem appears +  % with macro expansion.				--kasal, 19aug04 +  \catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active \escapechar=`\@ +  % +  % ... and for \example: +  \spaceisspace +  % +  % The \empty here causes a following catcode 5 newline to be eaten as +  % part of reading whitespace after a control sequence.  It does not +  % eat a catcode 13 newline.  There's no good way to handle the two +  % cases (untried: maybe e-TeX's \everyeof could help, though plain TeX +  % would then have different behavior).  See the Macro Details node in +  % the manual for the workaround we recommend for macros and +  % line-oriented commands. +  % +  \scantokens{#1\empty}% +\endgroup} + +\def\scanexp#1{% +  \edef\temp{\noexpand\scanmacro{#1}}% +  \temp +} + +\newcount\paramno   % Count of parameters +\newtoks\macname    % Macro name +\newif\ifrecursive  % Is it recursive? + +% List of all defined macros in the form +%    \definedummyword\macro1\definedummyword\macro2... +% Currently is also contains all @aliases; the list can be split +% if there is a need. +\def\macrolist{} + +% Add the macro to \macrolist +\def\addtomacrolist#1{\expandafter \addtomacrolistxxx \csname#1\endcsname} +\def\addtomacrolistxxx#1{% +     \toks0 = \expandafter{\macrolist\definedummyword#1}% +     \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0}% +} + +% Utility routines. +% This does \let #1 = #2, with \csnames; that is, +%   \let \csname#1\endcsname = \csname#2\endcsname +% (except of course we have to play expansion games). +% +\def\cslet#1#2{% +  \expandafter\let +  \csname#1\expandafter\endcsname +  \csname#2\endcsname +} + +% Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string. +% Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN). +{\catcode`\@=11 +\gdef\eatspaces #1{\expandafter\trim@\expandafter{#1 }} +\gdef\trim@ #1{\trim@@ @#1 @ #1 @ @@} +\gdef\trim@@ #1@ #2@ #3@@{\trim@@@\empty #2 @} +\def\unbrace#1{#1} +\unbrace{\gdef\trim@@@ #1 } #2@{#1} +} + +% Trim a single trailing ^^M off a string. +{\catcode`\^^M=\other \catcode`\Q=3% +\gdef\eatcr #1{\eatcra #1Q^^MQ}% +\gdef\eatcra#1^^MQ{\eatcrb#1Q}% +\gdef\eatcrb#1Q#2Q{#1}% +} + +% Macro bodies are absorbed as an argument in a context where +% all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active +% (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \ +% to recognize macro arguments; this is the job of \mbodybackslash. +% +% Non-ASCII encodings make 8-bit characters active, so un-activate +% them to avoid their expansion.  Must do this non-globally, to +% confine the change to the current group. +% +% It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is +% done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro +% body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro. +% +\def\scanctxt{% used as subroutine +  \catcode`\"=\other +  \catcode`\+=\other +  \catcode`\<=\other +  \catcode`\>=\other +  \catcode`\@=\other +  \catcode`\^=\other +  \catcode`\_=\other +  \catcode`\|=\other +  \catcode`\~=\other +  \ifx\declaredencoding\ascii \else \setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal\other \fi +} + +\def\scanargctxt{% used for copying and captions, not macros. +  \scanctxt +  \catcode`\\=\other +  \catcode`\^^M=\other +} + +\def\macrobodyctxt{% used for @macro definitions +  \scanctxt +  \catcode`\{=\other +  \catcode`\}=\other +  \catcode`\^^M=\other +  \usembodybackslash +} + +\def\macroargctxt{% used when scanning invocations +  \scanctxt +  \catcode`\\=0 +} +% why catcode 0 for \ in the above?  To recognize \\ \{ \} as "escapes" +% for the single characters \ { }.  Thus, we end up with the "commands" +% that would be written @\ @{ @} in a Texinfo document. +% +% We already have @{ and @}.  For @\, we define it here, and only for +% this purpose, to produce a typewriter backslash (so, the @\ that we +% define for @math can't be used with @macro calls): +% +\def\\{\normalbackslash}% +% +% We would like to do this for \, too, since that is what makeinfo does. +% But it is not possible, because Texinfo already has a command @, for a +% cedilla accent.  Documents must use @comma{} instead. +% +% \anythingelse will almost certainly be an error of some kind. + + +% \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies. +% It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N +% where N is the macro parameter number. +% We define \csname macarg.\endcsname to be \realbackslash, so +% \\ in macro replacement text gets you a backslash. +% +{\catcode`@=0 @catcode`@\=@active + @gdef@usembodybackslash{@let\=@mbodybackslash} + @gdef@mbodybackslash#1\{@csname macarg.#1@endcsname} +} +\expandafter\def\csname macarg.\endcsname{\realbackslash} + +\def\margbackslash#1{\char`\#1 } + +\def\macro{\recursivefalse\parsearg\macroxxx} +\def\rmacro{\recursivetrue\parsearg\macroxxx} + +\def\macroxxx#1{% +  \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist +  \ifx\argl\empty       % no arguments +     \paramno=0\relax +  \else +     \expandafter\parsemargdef \argl;% +     \if\paramno>256\relax +       \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined +         \errhelp = \EMsimple +         \errmessage{You need eTeX to compile a file with macros with more than 256 arguments} +       \fi +     \fi +  \fi +  \if1\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname +     \message{Warning: redefining \the\macname}% +  \else +     \expandafter\ifx\csname \the\macname\endcsname \relax +     \else \errmessage{Macro name \the\macname\space already defined}\fi +     \global\cslet{macsave.\the\macname}{\the\macname}% +     \global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname=1% +     \addtomacrolist{\the\macname}% +  \fi +  \begingroup \macrobodyctxt +  \ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody +  \else \expandafter\parsemacbody +  \fi} + +\parseargdef\unmacro{% +  \if1\csname ismacro.#1\endcsname +    \global\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}% +    \global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.#1\endcsname=0% +    % Remove the macro name from \macrolist: +    \begingroup +      \expandafter\let\csname#1\endcsname \relax +      \let\definedummyword\unmacrodo +      \xdef\macrolist{\macrolist}% +    \endgroup +  \else +    \errmessage{Macro #1 not defined}% +  \fi +} + +% Called by \do from \dounmacro on each macro.  The idea is to omit any +% macro definitions that have been changed to \relax. +% +\def\unmacrodo#1{% +  \ifx #1\relax +    % remove this +  \else +    \noexpand\definedummyword \noexpand#1% +  \fi +} + +% This makes use of the obscure feature that if the last token of a +% <parameter list> is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by +% an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed. +\def\getargs#1{\getargsxxx#1{}} +\def\getargsxxx#1#{\getmacname #1 \relax\getmacargs} +\def\getmacname#1 #2\relax{\macname={#1}} +\def\getmacargs#1{\def\argl{#1}} + +% For macro processing make @ a letter so that we can make Texinfo private macro names. +\edef\texiatcatcode{\the\catcode`\@} +\catcode `@=11\relax + +% Parse the optional {params} list.  Set up \paramno and \paramlist +% so \defmacro knows what to do.  Define \macarg.BLAH for each BLAH +% in the params list to some hook where the argument si to be expanded.  If +% there are less than 10 arguments that hook is to be replaced by ##N where N +% is the position in that list, that is to say the macro arguments are to be +% defined `a la TeX in the macro body. +% +% That gets used by \mbodybackslash (above). +% +% We need to get `macro parameter char #' into several definitions. +% The technique used is stolen from LaTeX: let \hash be something +% unexpandable, insert that wherever you need a #, and then redefine +% it to # just before using the token list produced. +% +% The same technique is used to protect \eatspaces till just before +% the macro is used. +% +% If there are 10 or more arguments, a different technique is used, where the +% hook remains in the body, and when macro is to be expanded the body is +% processed again to replace the arguments. +% +% In that case, the hook is \the\toks N-1, and we simply set \toks N-1 to the +% argument N value and then \edef  the body (nothing else will expand because of +% the catcode regime underwhich the body was input). +% +% If you compile with TeX (not eTeX), and you have macros with 10 or more +% arguments, you need that no macro has more than 256 arguments, otherwise an +% error is produced. +\def\parsemargdef#1;{% +  \paramno=0\def\paramlist{}% +  \let\hash\relax +  \let\xeatspaces\relax +  \parsemargdefxxx#1,;,% +  % In case that there are 10 or more arguments we parse again the arguments +  % list to set new definitions for the \macarg.BLAH macros corresponding to +  % each BLAH argument. It was anyhow needed to parse already once this list +  % in order to count the arguments, and as macros with at most 9 arguments +  % are by far more frequent than macro with 10 or more arguments, defining +  % twice the \macarg.BLAH macros does not cost too much processing power. +  \ifnum\paramno<10\relax\else +    \paramno0\relax +    \parsemmanyargdef@@#1,;,% 10 or more arguments +  \fi +} +\def\parsemargdefxxx#1,{% +  \if#1;\let\next=\relax +  \else \let\next=\parsemargdefxxx +    \advance\paramno by 1 +    \expandafter\edef\csname macarg.\eatspaces{#1}\endcsname +        {\xeatspaces{\hash\the\paramno}}% +    \edef\paramlist{\paramlist\hash\the\paramno,}% +  \fi\next} + +\def\parsemmanyargdef@@#1,{% +  \if#1;\let\next=\relax +  \else +    \let\next=\parsemmanyargdef@@ +    \edef\tempb{\eatspaces{#1}}% +    \expandafter\def\expandafter\tempa +       \expandafter{\csname macarg.\tempb\endcsname}% +    % Note that we need some extra \noexpand\noexpand, this is because we +    % don't want \the  to be expanded in the \parsermacbody  as it uses an +    % \xdef . +    \expandafter\edef\tempa +      {\noexpand\noexpand\noexpand\the\toks\the\paramno}% +    \advance\paramno by 1\relax +  \fi\next} + +% These two commands read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies. +% (They're different since rec and nonrec macros end differently.) +% + +\catcode `\@\texiatcatcode +\long\def\parsemacbody#1@end macro% +{\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}% +\long\def\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro% +{\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}% +\catcode `\@=11\relax + +\let\endargs@\relax +\let\nil@\relax +\def\nilm@{\nil@}% +\long\def\nillm@{\nil@}% + +% This macro is expanded during the Texinfo macro expansion, not during its +% definition.  It gets all the arguments values and assigns them to macros +% macarg.ARGNAME +% +% #1 is the macro name +% #2 is the list of argument names +% #3 is the list of argument values +\def\getargvals@#1#2#3{% +  \def\macargdeflist@{}% +  \def\saveparamlist@{#2}% Need to keep a copy for parameter expansion. +  \def\paramlist{#2,\nil@}% +  \def\macroname{#1}% +  \begingroup +  \macroargctxt +  \def\argvaluelist{#3,\nil@}% +  \def\@tempa{#3}% +  \ifx\@tempa\empty +    \setemptyargvalues@ +  \else +    \getargvals@@ +  \fi +} + +% +\def\getargvals@@{% +  \ifx\paramlist\nilm@ +      % Some sanity check needed here that \argvaluelist is also empty. +      \ifx\argvaluelist\nillm@ +      \else +        \errhelp = \EMsimple +        \errmessage{Too many arguments in macro `\macroname'!}% +      \fi +      \let\next\macargexpandinbody@ +  \else +    \ifx\argvaluelist\nillm@ +       % No more arguments values passed to macro.  Set remaining named-arg +       % macros to empty. +       \let\next\setemptyargvalues@ +    \else +      % pop current arg name into \@tempb +      \def\@tempa##1{\pop@{\@tempb}{\paramlist}##1\endargs@}% +      \expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\paramlist}% +       % pop current argument value into \@tempc +      \def\@tempa##1{\longpop@{\@tempc}{\argvaluelist}##1\endargs@}% +      \expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\argvaluelist}% +       % Here \@tempb is the current arg name and \@tempc is the current arg value. +       % First place the new argument macro definition into \@tempd +       \expandafter\macname\expandafter{\@tempc}% +       \expandafter\let\csname macarg.\@tempb\endcsname\relax +       \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempe\expandafter{% +         \csname macarg.\@tempb\endcsname}% +       \edef\@tempd{\long\def\@tempe{\the\macname}}% +       \push@\@tempd\macargdeflist@ +       \let\next\getargvals@@ +    \fi +  \fi +  \next +} + +\def\push@#1#2{% +  \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\def +  \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter#2% +  \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter{% +  \expandafter#1#2}% +} + +% Replace arguments by their values in the macro body, and place the result +% in macro \@tempa +\def\macvalstoargs@{% +  %  To do this we use the property that token registers that are \the'ed +  % within an \edef  expand only once. So we are going to place all argument +  % values into respective token registers. +  % +  % First we save the token context, and initialize argument numbering. +  \begingroup +    \paramno0\relax +    % Then, for each argument number #N, we place the corresponding argument +    % value into a new token list register \toks#N +    \expandafter\putargsintokens@\saveparamlist@,;,% +    % Then, we expand the body so that argument are replaced by their +    % values. The trick for values not to be expanded themselves is that they +    % are within tokens and that tokens expand only once in an \edef . +    \edef\@tempc{\csname mac.\macroname .body\endcsname}% +    % Now we restore the token stack pointer to free the token list registers +    % which we have used, but we make sure that expanded body is saved after +    % group. +    \expandafter +  \endgroup +  \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\@tempc}% +  } + +\def\macargexpandinbody@{% +  %% Define the named-macro outside of this group and then close this group. +  \expandafter +  \endgroup +  \macargdeflist@ +  % First the replace in body the macro arguments by their values, the result +  % is in \@tempa . +  \macvalstoargs@ +  % Then we point at the \norecurse or \gobble (for recursive) macro value +  % with \@tempb . +  \expandafter\let\expandafter\@tempb\csname mac.\macroname .recurse\endcsname +  % Depending on whether it is recursive or not, we need some tailing +  % \egroup . +  \ifx\@tempb\gobble +     \let\@tempc\relax +  \else +     \let\@tempc\egroup +  \fi +  % And now we do the real job: +  \edef\@tempd{\noexpand\@tempb{\macroname}\noexpand\scanmacro{\@tempa}\@tempc}% +  \@tempd +} + +\def\putargsintokens@#1,{% +  \if#1;\let\next\relax +  \else +    \let\next\putargsintokens@ +    % First we allocate the new token list register, and give it a temporary +    % alias \@tempb . +    \toksdef\@tempb\the\paramno +    % Then we place the argument value into that token list register. +    \expandafter\let\expandafter\@tempa\csname macarg.#1\endcsname +    \expandafter\@tempb\expandafter{\@tempa}% +    \advance\paramno by 1\relax +  \fi +  \next +} + +% Save the token stack pointer into macro #1 +\def\texisavetoksstackpoint#1{\edef#1{\the\@cclvi}} +% Restore the token stack pointer from number in macro #1 +\def\texirestoretoksstackpoint#1{\expandafter\mathchardef\expandafter\@cclvi#1\relax} +% newtoks that can be used non \outer . +\def\texinonouternewtoks{\alloc@ 5\toks \toksdef \@cclvi} + +% Tailing missing arguments are set to empty +\def\setemptyargvalues@{% +  \ifx\paramlist\nilm@ +    \let\next\macargexpandinbody@ +  \else +    \expandafter\setemptyargvaluesparser@\paramlist\endargs@ +    \let\next\setemptyargvalues@ +  \fi +  \next +} + +\def\setemptyargvaluesparser@#1,#2\endargs@{% +  \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{% +    \expandafter\def\csname macarg.#1\endcsname{}}% +  \push@\@tempa\macargdeflist@ +  \def\paramlist{#2}% +} + +% #1 is the element target macro +% #2 is the list macro +% #3,#4\endargs@ is the list value +\def\pop@#1#2#3,#4\endargs@{% +   \def#1{#3}% +   \def#2{#4}% +} +\long\def\longpop@#1#2#3,#4\endargs@{% +   \long\def#1{#3}% +   \long\def#2{#4}% +} + +% This defines a Texinfo @macro. There are eight cases: recursive and +% nonrecursive macros of zero, one, up to nine, and many arguments. +% Much magic with \expandafter here. +% \xdef is used so that macro definitions will survive the file +% they're defined in; @include reads the file inside a group. +% +\def\defmacro{% +  \let\hash=##% convert placeholders to macro parameter chars +  \ifrecursive +    \ifcase\paramno +    % 0 +      \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% +        \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% +    \or % 1 +      \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% +         \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt +         \noexpand\braceorline +         \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}% +      \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{% +         \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% +    \else +      \ifnum\paramno<10\relax % at most 9 +        \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% +           \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt +           \noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}% +        \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{% +            \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}% +        \expandafter\expandafter +        \expandafter\xdef +        \expandafter\expandafter +          \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname +            \paramlist{\egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% +      \else % 10 or more +        \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% +          \noexpand\getargvals@{\the\macname}{\argl}% +        }% +        \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .body\endcsname\temp +        \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .recurse\endcsname\gobble +      \fi +    \fi +  \else +    \ifcase\paramno +    % 0 +      \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% +        \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% +        \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% +    \or % 1 +      \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% +         \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt +         \noexpand\braceorline +         \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}% +      \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{% +        \egroup +        \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% +        \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% +    \else % at most 9 +      \ifnum\paramno<10\relax +        \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% +           \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt +           \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}% +        \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{% +            \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}% +        \expandafter\expandafter +        \expandafter\xdef +        \expandafter\expandafter +        \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname +        \paramlist{% +            \egroup +            \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% +            \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% +      \else % 10 or more: +        \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% +          \noexpand\getargvals@{\the\macname}{\argl}% +        }% +        \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .body\endcsname\temp +        \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .recurse\endcsname\norecurse +      \fi +    \fi +  \fi} + +\catcode `\@\texiatcatcode\relax + +\def\norecurse#1{\bgroup\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}} + +% \braceorline decides whether the next nonwhitespace character is a +% {.  If so it reads up to the closing }, if not, it reads the whole +% line.  Whatever was read is then fed to the next control sequence +% as an argument (by \parsebrace or \parsearg). +% +\def\braceorline#1{\let\macnamexxx=#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx} +\def\braceorlinexxx{% +  \ifx\nchar\bgroup\else +    \expandafter\parsearg +  \fi \macnamexxx} + + +% @alias. +% We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal +% sign.  Make them active and then expand them all to nothing. +% +\def\alias{\parseargusing\obeyspaces\aliasxxx} +\def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax} +\def\aliasyyy #1=#2\relax{% +  {% +    \expandafter\let\obeyedspace=\empty +    \addtomacrolist{#1}% +    \xdef\next{\global\let\makecsname{#1}=\makecsname{#2}}% +  }% +  \next +} + + +\message{cross references,} + +\newwrite\auxfile +\newif\ifhavexrefs    % True if xref values are known. +\newif\ifwarnedxrefs  % True if we warned once that they aren't known. + +% @inforef is relatively simple. +\def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**} +\def\inforefzzz #1,#2,#3,#4**{% +  \putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}}, +  node \samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}} + +% @node's only job in TeX is to define \lastnode, which is used in +% cross-references.  The @node line might or might not have commas, and +% might or might not have spaces before the first comma, like: +% @node foo , bar , ... +% We don't want such trailing spaces in the node name. +% +\parseargdef\node{\checkenv{}\donode #1 ,\finishnodeparse} +% +% also remove a trailing comma, in case of something like this: +% @node Help-Cross,  ,  , Cross-refs +\def\donode#1 ,#2\finishnodeparse{\dodonode #1,\finishnodeparse} +\def\dodonode#1,#2\finishnodeparse{\gdef\lastnode{#1}} + +\let\nwnode=\node +\let\lastnode=\empty + +% Write a cross-reference definition for the current node.  #1 is the +% type (Ynumbered, Yappendix, Ynothing). +% +\def\donoderef#1{% +  \ifx\lastnode\empty\else +    \setref{\lastnode}{#1}% +    \global\let\lastnode=\empty +  \fi +} + +% @anchor{NAME} -- define xref target at arbitrary point. +% +\newcount\savesfregister +% +\def\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=\spacefactor \fi} +\def\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=\savesfregister \fi} +\def\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing}\restoresf \ignorespaces} + +% \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME (a node or an +% anchor), which consists of three parts: +% 1) NAME-title - the current sectioning name taken from \lastsection, +%                 or the anchor name. +% 2) NAME-snt   - section number and type, passed as the SNT arg, or +%                 empty for anchors. +% 3) NAME-pg    - the page number. +% +% This is called from \donoderef, \anchor, and \dofloat.  In the case of +% floats, there is an additional part, which is not written here: +% 4) NAME-lof   - the text as it should appear in a @listoffloats. +% +\def\setref#1#2{% +  \pdfmkdest{#1}% +  \iflinks +    {% +      \atdummies  % preserve commands, but don't expand them +      \edef\writexrdef##1##2{% +	\write\auxfile{@xrdef{#1-% #1 of \setref, expanded by the \edef +	  ##1}{##2}}% these are parameters of \writexrdef +      }% +      \toks0 = \expandafter{\lastsection}% +      \immediate \writexrdef{title}{\the\toks0 }% +      \immediate \writexrdef{snt}{\csname #2\endcsname}% \Ynumbered etc. +      \safewhatsit{\writexrdef{pg}{\folio}}% will be written later, at \shipout +    }% +  \fi +} + +% @xrefautosectiontitle on|off says whether @section(ing) names are used +% automatically in xrefs, if the third arg is not explicitly specified. +% This was provided as a "secret" @set xref-automatic-section-title +% variable, now it's official. +% +\parseargdef\xrefautomaticsectiontitle{% +  \def\temp{#1}% +  \ifx\temp\onword +    \expandafter\let\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname +      = \empty +  \else\ifx\temp\offword +    \expandafter\let\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname +      = \relax +  \else +    \errhelp = \EMsimple +    \errmessage{Unknown @xrefautomaticsectiontitle value `\temp', +                must be on|off}% +  \fi\fi +} + +%  +% @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references.  For \xrefX, #1 is +% the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed +% node name, #4 the name of the Info file, #5 the name of the printed +% manual.  All but the node name can be omitted. +% +\def\pxref#1{\putwordsee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} +\def\xref#1{\putwordSee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} +\def\ref#1{\xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} +% +\newbox\toprefbox +\newbox\printedrefnamebox +\newbox\infofilenamebox +\newbox\printedmanualbox +% +\def\xrefX[#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6]{\begingroup +  \unsepspaces +  % +  % Get args without leading/trailing spaces. +  \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #3}% +  \setbox\printedrefnamebox = \hbox{\printedrefname\unskip}% +  % +  \def\infofilename{\ignorespaces #4}% +  \setbox\infofilenamebox = \hbox{\infofilename\unskip}% +  % +  \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}% +  \setbox\printedmanualbox  = \hbox{\printedmanual\unskip}% +  % +  % If the printed reference name (arg #3) was not explicitly given in +  % the @xref, figure out what we want to use. +  \ifdim \wd\printedrefnamebox = 0pt +    % No printed node name was explicitly given. +    \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname \relax +      % Not auto section-title: use node name inside the square brackets. +      \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}% +    \else +      % Auto section-title: use chapter/section title inside +      % the square brackets if we have it. +      \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt +        % It is in another manual, so we don't have it; use node name. +        \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}% +      \else +        \ifhavexrefs +          % We (should) know the real title if we have the xref values. +          \def\printedrefname{\refx{#1-title}{}}% +        \else +          % Otherwise just copy the Info node name. +          \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}% +        \fi% +      \fi +    \fi +  \fi +  % +  % Make link in pdf output. +  \ifpdf +    {\indexnofonts +     \turnoffactive +     \makevalueexpandable +     % This expands tokens, so do it after making catcode changes, so _ +     % etc. don't get their TeX definitions.  This ignores all spaces in +     % #4, including (wrongly) those in the middle of the filename. +     \getfilename{#4}% +     % +     % This (wrongly) does not take account of leading or trailing +     % spaces in #1, which should be ignored. +     \edef\pdfxrefdest{#1}% +     \ifx\pdfxrefdest\empty +       \def\pdfxrefdest{Top}% no empty targets +     \else +       \txiescapepdf\pdfxrefdest  % escape PDF special chars +     \fi +     % +     \leavevmode +     \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}% +     \ifnum\filenamelength>0 +       goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{\pdfxrefdest}% +     \else +       goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfxrefdest}}% +     \fi +    }% +    \setcolor{\linkcolor}% +  \fi +  % +  % Float references are printed completely differently: "Figure 1.2" +  % instead of "[somenode], p.3".  We distinguish them by the +  % LABEL-title being set to a magic string. +  {% +    % Have to otherify everything special to allow the \csname to +    % include an _ in the xref name, etc. +    \indexnofonts +    \turnoffactive +    \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\Xthisreftitle +      \csname XR#1-title\endcsname +  }% +  \iffloat\Xthisreftitle +    % If the user specified the print name (third arg) to the ref, +    % print it instead of our usual "Figure 1.2". +    \ifdim\wd\printedrefnamebox = 0pt +      \refx{#1-snt}{}% +    \else +      \printedrefname +    \fi +    % +    % If the user also gave the printed manual name (fifth arg), append +    % "in MANUALNAME". +    \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt +      \space \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}% +    \fi +  \else +    % node/anchor (non-float) references. +    % +    % If we use \unhbox to print the node names, TeX does not insert +    % empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will not +    % find a line break at a hyphen in a node names.  Since some manuals +    % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens, +    % this is a loss.  Therefore, we give the text of the node name +    % again, so it is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time. +    % +    \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt +      % Cross-manual reference with a printed manual name. +      % +      \crossmanualxref{\cite{\printedmanual\unskip}}% +    % +    \else\ifdim \wd\infofilenamebox > 0pt +      % Cross-manual reference with only an info filename (arg 4), no +      % printed manual name (arg 5).  This is essentially the same as +      % the case above; we output the filename, since we have nothing else. +      % +      \crossmanualxref{\code{\infofilename\unskip}}% +    % +    \else +      % Reference within this manual. +      % +      % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the +      % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand +      % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of +      % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the +      % printing, back off for the \refx-pg. +      {\turnoffactive +       % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for +       % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be. +       \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt}{}}% +       \ifdim \wd2 > 0pt \refx{#1-snt}\space\fi +      }% +      % output the `[mynode]' via the macro below so it can be overridden. +      \xrefprintnodename\printedrefname +      % +      % But we always want a comma and a space: +      ,\space +      % +      % output the `page 3'. +      \turnoffactive \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}% +    \fi\fi +  \fi +  \endlink +\endgroup} + +% Output a cross-manual xref to #1.  Used just above (twice). +% +% Only include the text "Section ``foo'' in" if the foo is neither +% missing or Top.  Thus, @xref{,,,foo,The Foo Manual} outputs simply +% "see The Foo Manual", the idea being to refer to the whole manual. +% +% But, this being TeX, we can't easily compare our node name against the +% string "Top" while ignoring the possible spaces before and after in +% the input.  By adding the arbitrary 7sp below, we make it much less +% likely that a real node name would have the same width as "Top" (e.g., +% in a monospaced font).  Hopefully it will never happen in practice. +% +% For the same basic reason, we retypeset the "Top" at every +% reference, since the current font is indeterminate. +% +\def\crossmanualxref#1{% +  \setbox\toprefbox = \hbox{Top\kern7sp}% +  \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \printedrefname \unskip \kern7sp}% +  \ifdim \wd2 > 7sp  % nonempty? +    \ifdim \wd2 = \wd\toprefbox \else  % same as Top? +      \putwordSection{} ``\printedrefname'' \putwordin{}\space +    \fi +  \fi +  #1% +} + +% This macro is called from \xrefX for the `[nodename]' part of xref +% output.  It's a separate macro only so it can be changed more easily, +% since square brackets don't work well in some documents.  Particularly +% one that Bob is working on :). +% +\def\xrefprintnodename#1{[#1]} + +% Things referred to by \setref. +% +\def\Ynothing{} +\def\Yomitfromtoc{} +\def\Ynumbered{% +  \ifnum\secno=0 +    \putwordChapter@tie \the\chapno +  \else \ifnum\subsecno=0 +    \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno +  \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0 +    \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno +  \else +    \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno +  \fi\fi\fi +} +\def\Yappendix{% +  \ifnum\secno=0 +     \putwordAppendix@tie @char\the\appendixno{}% +  \else \ifnum\subsecno=0 +     \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno +  \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0 +    \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno +  \else +    \putwordSection@tie +      @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno +  \fi\fi\fi +} + +% Define \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} to reference a cross-reference string named NAME. +% If its value is nonempty, SUFFIX is output afterward. +% +\def\refx#1#2{% +  {% +    \indexnofonts +    \otherbackslash +    \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\thisrefX +      \csname XR#1\endcsname +  }% +  \ifx\thisrefX\relax +    % If not defined, say something at least. +    \angleleft un\-de\-fined\angleright +    \iflinks +      \ifhavexrefs +        {\toks0 = {#1}% avoid expansion of possibly-complex value +         \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `\the\toks0'.}}% +      \else +        \ifwarnedxrefs\else +          \global\warnedxrefstrue +          \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.}% +        \fi +      \fi +    \fi +  \else +    % It's defined, so just use it. +    \thisrefX +  \fi +  #2% Output the suffix in any case. +} + +% This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file.  Usually it's +% just a \def (we prepend XR to the control sequence name to avoid +% collisions).  But if this is a float type, we have more work to do. +% +\def\xrdef#1#2{% +  {% The node name might contain 8-bit characters, which in our current +   % implementation are changed to commands like @'e.  Don't let these +   % mess up the control sequence name. +    \indexnofonts +    \turnoffactive +    \xdef\safexrefname{#1}% +  }% +  % +  \expandafter\gdef\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname{#2}% remember this xref +  % +  % Was that xref control sequence that we just defined for a float? +  \expandafter\iffloat\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname +    % it was a float, and we have the (safe) float type in \iffloattype. +    \expandafter\let\expandafter\floatlist +      \csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname +    % +    % Is this the first time we've seen this float type? +    \expandafter\ifx\floatlist\relax +      \toks0 = {\do}% yes, so just \do +    \else +      % had it before, so preserve previous elements in list. +      \toks0 = \expandafter{\floatlist\do}% +    \fi +    % +    % Remember this xref in the control sequence \floatlistFLOATTYPE, +    % for later use in \listoffloats. +    \expandafter\xdef\csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname{\the\toks0 +      {\safexrefname}}% +  \fi +} + +% Read the last existing aux file, if any.  No error if none exists. +% +\def\tryauxfile{% +  \openin 1 \jobname.aux +  \ifeof 1 \else +    \readdatafile{aux}% +    \global\havexrefstrue +  \fi +  \closein 1 +} + +\def\setupdatafile{% +  \catcode`\^^@=\other +  \catcode`\^^A=\other +  \catcode`\^^B=\other +  \catcode`\^^C=\other +  \catcode`\^^D=\other +  \catcode`\^^E=\other +  \catcode`\^^F=\other +  \catcode`\^^G=\other +  \catcode`\^^H=\other +  \catcode`\^^K=\other +  \catcode`\^^L=\other +  \catcode`\^^N=\other +  \catcode`\^^P=\other +  \catcode`\^^Q=\other +  \catcode`\^^R=\other +  \catcode`\^^S=\other +  \catcode`\^^T=\other +  \catcode`\^^U=\other +  \catcode`\^^V=\other +  \catcode`\^^W=\other +  \catcode`\^^X=\other +  \catcode`\^^Z=\other +  \catcode`\^^[=\other +  \catcode`\^^\=\other +  \catcode`\^^]=\other +  \catcode`\^^^=\other +  \catcode`\^^_=\other +  % It was suggested to set the catcode of ^ to 7, which would allow ^^e4 etc. +  % in xref tags, i.e., node names.  But since ^^e4 notation isn't +  % supported in the main text, it doesn't seem desirable.  Furthermore, +  % that is not enough: for node names that actually contain a ^ +  % character, we would end up writing a line like this: 'xrdef {'hat +  % b-title}{'hat b} and \xrdef does a \csname...\endcsname on the first +  % argument, and \hat is not an expandable control sequence.  It could +  % all be worked out, but why?  Either we support ^^ or we don't. +  % +  % The other change necessary for this was to define \auxhat: +  % \def\auxhat{\def^{'hat }}% extra space so ok if followed by letter +  % and then to call \auxhat in \setq. +  % +  \catcode`\^=\other +  % +  % Special characters.  Should be turned off anyway, but... +  \catcode`\~=\other +  \catcode`\[=\other +  \catcode`\]=\other +  \catcode`\"=\other +  \catcode`\_=\other +  \catcode`\|=\other +  \catcode`\<=\other +  \catcode`\>=\other +  \catcode`\$=\other +  \catcode`\#=\other +  \catcode`\&=\other +  \catcode`\%=\other +  \catcode`+=\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off +  % +  % This is to support \ in node names and titles, since the \ +  % characters end up in a \csname.  It's easier than +  % leaving it active and making its active definition an actual \ +  % character.  What I don't understand is why it works in the *value* +  % of the xrdef.  Seems like it should be a catcode12 \, and that +  % should not typeset properly.  But it works, so I'm moving on for +  % now.  --karl, 15jan04. +  \catcode`\\=\other +  % +  % Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters. +  {% +    \count1=128 +    \def\loop{% +      \catcode\count1=\other +      \advance\count1 by 1 +      \ifnum \count1<256 \loop \fi +    }% +  }% +  % +  % @ is our escape character in .aux files, and we need braces. +  \catcode`\{=1 +  \catcode`\}=2 +  \catcode`\@=0 +} + +\def\readdatafile#1{% +\begingroup +  \setupdatafile +  \input\jobname.#1 +\endgroup} + + +\message{insertions,} +% including footnotes. + +\newcount \footnoteno + +% The trailing space in the following definition for supereject is +% vital for proper filling; pages come out unaligned when you do a +% pagealignmacro call if that space before the closing brace is +% removed. (Generally, numeric constants should always be followed by a +% space to prevent strange expansion errors.) +\def\supereject{\par\penalty -20000\footnoteno =0 } + +% @footnotestyle is meaningful for Info output only. +\let\footnotestyle=\comment + +{\catcode `\@=11 +% +% Auto-number footnotes.  Otherwise like plain. +\gdef\footnote{% +  \let\indent=\ptexindent +  \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent +  \global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne +  \edef\thisfootno{$^{\the\footnoteno}$}% +  % +  % In case the footnote comes at the end of a sentence, preserve the +  % extra spacing after we do the footnote number. +  \let\@sf\empty +  \ifhmode\edef\@sf{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\ptexslash\fi +  % +  % Remove inadvertent blank space before typesetting the footnote number. +  \unskip +  \thisfootno\@sf +  \dofootnote +}% + +% Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the +% footnote text as a parameter.  Our footnotes don't need to be so general. +% +% Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset (and anything else that uses +% \parseargline) fails inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when +% the footnote is read.  --karl, 16nov96. +% +\gdef\dofootnote{% +  \insert\footins\bgroup +  % We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the +  % footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment. +  % So reset some parameters. +  \hsize=\pagewidth +  \interlinepenalty\interfootnotelinepenalty +  \splittopskip\ht\strutbox % top baseline for broken footnotes +  \splitmaxdepth\dp\strutbox +  \floatingpenalty\@MM +  \leftskip\z@skip +  \rightskip\z@skip +  \spaceskip\z@skip +  \xspaceskip\z@skip +  \parindent\defaultparindent +  % +  \smallfonts \rm +  % +  % Because we use hanging indentation in footnotes, a @noindent appears +  % to exdent this text, so make it be a no-op.  makeinfo does not use +  % hanging indentation so @noindent can still be needed within footnote +  % text after an @example or the like (not that this is good style). +  \let\noindent = \relax +  % +  % Hang the footnote text off the number.  Use \everypar in case the +  % footnote extends for more than one paragraph. +  \everypar = {\hang}% +  \textindent{\thisfootno}% +  % +  % Don't crash into the line above the footnote text.  Since this +  % expands into a box, it must come within the paragraph, lest it +  % provide a place where TeX can split the footnote. +  \footstrut +  % +  % Invoke rest of plain TeX footnote routine. +  \futurelet\next\fo@t +} +}%end \catcode `\@=11 + +% In case a @footnote appears in a vbox, save the footnote text and create +% the real \insert just after the vbox finished.  Otherwise, the insertion +% would be lost. +% Similarly, if a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote +% text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is finished. +% And the same can be done for other insert classes.  --kasal, 16nov03. + +% Replace the \insert primitive by a cheating macro. +% Deeper inside, just make sure that the saved insertions are not spilled +% out prematurely. +% +\def\startsavinginserts{% +  \ifx \insert\ptexinsert +    \let\insert\saveinsert +  \else +    \let\checkinserts\relax +  \fi +} + +% This \insert replacement works for both \insert\footins{foo} and +% \insert\footins\bgroup foo\egroup, but it doesn't work for \insert27{foo}. +% +\def\saveinsert#1{% +  \edef\next{\noexpand\savetobox \makeSAVEname#1}% +  \afterassignment\next +  % swallow the left brace +  \let\temp = +} +\def\makeSAVEname#1{\makecsname{SAVE\expandafter\gobble\string#1}} +\def\savetobox#1{\global\setbox#1 = \vbox\bgroup \unvbox#1} + +\def\checksaveins#1{\ifvoid#1\else \placesaveins#1\fi} + +\def\placesaveins#1{% +  \ptexinsert \csname\expandafter\gobblesave\string#1\endcsname +    {\box#1}% +} + +% eat @SAVE -- beware, all of them have catcode \other: +{ +  \def\dospecials{\do S\do A\do V\do E} \uncatcodespecials  %  ;-) +  \gdef\gobblesave @SAVE{} +} + +% initialization: +\def\newsaveins #1{% +  \edef\next{\noexpand\newsaveinsX \makeSAVEname#1}% +  \next +} +\def\newsaveinsX #1{% +  \csname newbox\endcsname #1% +  \expandafter\def\expandafter\checkinserts\expandafter{\checkinserts +    \checksaveins #1}% +} + +% initialize: +\let\checkinserts\empty +\newsaveins\footins +\newsaveins\margin + + +% @image.  We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this. +% If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain. +% +% Check for and read epsf.tex up front.  If we read it only at @image +% time, we might be inside a group, and then its definitions would get +% undone and the next image would fail. +\openin 1 = epsf.tex +\ifeof 1 \else +  % Do not bother showing banner with epsf.tex v2.7k (available in +  % doc/epsf.tex and on ctan). +  \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 = }% +  \input epsf.tex +\fi +\closein 1 +% +% We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex. +\newif\ifwarnednoepsf +\newhelp\noepsfhelp{epsf.tex must be installed for images to +  work.  It is also included in the Texinfo distribution, or you can get +  it from ftp://tug.org/tex/epsf.tex.} +% +\def\image#1{% +  \ifx\epsfbox\thisisundefined +    \ifwarnednoepsf \else +      \errhelp = \noepsfhelp +      \errmessage{epsf.tex not found, images will be ignored}% +      \global\warnednoepsftrue +    \fi +  \else +    \imagexxx #1,,,,,\finish +  \fi +} +% +% Arguments to @image: +% #1 is (mandatory) image filename; we tack on .eps extension. +% #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height. +% #4 is (ignored optional) html alt text. +% #5 is (ignored optional) extension. +% #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing stuff. +\newif\ifimagevmode +\def\imagexxx#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6\finish{\begingroup +  \catcode`\^^M = 5     % in case we're inside an example +  \normalturnoffactive  % allow _ et al. in names +  % If the image is by itself, center it. +  \ifvmode +    \imagevmodetrue +  \else \ifx\centersub\centerV +    % for @center @image, we need a vbox so we can have our vertical space +    \imagevmodetrue +    \vbox\bgroup % vbox has better behavior than vtop herev +  \fi\fi +  % +  \ifimagevmode +    \nobreak\medskip +    % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert +    % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space +    % above and below. +    \nobreak\vskip\parskip +    \nobreak +  \fi +  % +  % Leave vertical mode so that indentation from an enclosing +  %  environment such as @quotation is respected. +  % However, if we're at the top level, we don't want the +  %  normal paragraph indentation. +  % On the other hand, if we are in the case of @center @image, we don't +  %  want to start a paragraph, which will create a hsize-width box and +  %  eradicate the centering. +  \ifx\centersub\centerV\else \noindent \fi +  % +  % Output the image. +  \ifpdf +    \dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}% +  \else +    % \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure. +    \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfxsize=#2\relax \fi +    \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfysize=#3\relax \fi +    \epsfbox{#1.eps}% +  \fi +  % +  \ifimagevmode +    \medskip  % space after a standalone image +  \fi +  \ifx\centersub\centerV \egroup \fi +\endgroup} + + +% @float FLOATTYPE,LABEL,LOC ... @end float for displayed figures, tables, +% etc.  We don't actually implement floating yet, we always include the +% float "here".  But it seemed the best name for the future. +% +\envparseargdef\float{\eatcommaspace\eatcommaspace\dofloat#1, , ,\finish} + +% There may be a space before second and/or third parameter; delete it. +\def\eatcommaspace#1, {#1,} + +% #1 is the optional FLOATTYPE, the text label for this float, typically +% "Figure", "Table", "Example", etc.  Can't contain commas.  If omitted, +% this float will not be numbered and cannot be referred to. +% +% #2 is the optional xref label.  Also must be present for the float to +% be referable. +% +% #3 is the optional positioning argument; for now, it is ignored.  It +% will somehow specify the positions allowed to float to (here, top, bottom). +% +% We keep a separate counter for each FLOATTYPE, which we reset at each +% chapter-level command. +\let\resetallfloatnos=\empty +% +\def\dofloat#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{% +  \let\thiscaption=\empty +  \let\thisshortcaption=\empty +  % +  % don't lose footnotes inside @float. +  % +  % BEWARE: when the floats start float, we have to issue warning whenever an +  % insert appears inside a float which could possibly float. --kasal, 26may04 +  % +  \startsavinginserts +  % +  % We can't be used inside a paragraph. +  \par +  % +  \vtop\bgroup +    \def\floattype{#1}% +    \def\floatlabel{#2}% +    \def\floatloc{#3}% we do nothing with this yet. +    % +    \ifx\floattype\empty +      \let\safefloattype=\empty +    \else +      {% +        % the floattype might have accents or other special characters, +        % but we need to use it in a control sequence name. +        \indexnofonts +        \turnoffactive +        \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}% +      }% +    \fi +    % +    % If label is given but no type, we handle that as the empty type. +    \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else +      % We want each FLOATTYPE to be numbered separately (Figure 1, +      % Table 1, Figure 2, ...).  (And if no label, no number.) +      % +      \expandafter\getfloatno\csname\safefloattype floatno\endcsname +      \global\advance\floatno by 1 +      % +      {% +        % This magic value for \lastsection is output by \setref as the +        % XREFLABEL-title value.  \xrefX uses it to distinguish float +        % labels (which have a completely different output format) from +        % node and anchor labels.  And \xrdef uses it to construct the +        % lists of floats. +        % +        \edef\lastsection{\floatmagic=\safefloattype}% +        \setref{\floatlabel}{Yfloat}% +      }% +    \fi +    % +    % start with \parskip glue, I guess. +    \vskip\parskip +    % +    % Don't suppress indentation if a float happens to start a section. +    \restorefirstparagraphindent +} + +% we have these possibilities: +% @float Foo,lbl & @caption{Cap}: Foo 1.1: Cap +% @float Foo,lbl & no caption:    Foo 1.1 +% @float Foo & @caption{Cap}:     Foo: Cap +% @float Foo & no caption:        Foo +% @float ,lbl & Caption{Cap}:     1.1: Cap +% @float ,lbl & no caption:       1.1 +% @float & @caption{Cap}:         Cap +% @float & no caption: +% +\def\Efloat{% +    \let\floatident = \empty +    % +    % In all cases, if we have a float type, it comes first. +    \ifx\floattype\empty \else \def\floatident{\floattype}\fi +    % +    % If we have an xref label, the number comes next. +    \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else +      \ifx\floattype\empty \else % if also had float type, need tie first. +        \appendtomacro\floatident{\tie}% +      \fi +      % the number. +      \appendtomacro\floatident{\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}% +    \fi +    % +    % Start the printed caption with what we've constructed in +    % \floatident, but keep it separate; we need \floatident again. +    \let\captionline = \floatident +    % +    \ifx\thiscaption\empty \else +      \ifx\floatident\empty \else +	\appendtomacro\captionline{: }% had ident, so need a colon between +      \fi +      % +      % caption text. +      \appendtomacro\captionline{\scanexp\thiscaption}% +    \fi +    % +    % If we have anything to print, print it, with space before. +    % Eventually this needs to become an \insert. +    \ifx\captionline\empty \else +      \vskip.5\parskip +      \captionline +      % +      % Space below caption. +      \vskip\parskip +    \fi +    % +    % If have an xref label, write the list of floats info.  Do this +    % after the caption, to avoid chance of it being a breakpoint. +    \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else +      % Write the text that goes in the lof to the aux file as +      % \floatlabel-lof.  Besides \floatident, we include the short +      % caption if specified, else the full caption if specified, else nothing. +      {% +        \atdummies +        % +        % since we read the caption text in the macro world, where ^^M +        % is turned into a normal character, we have to scan it back, so +        % we don't write the literal three characters "^^M" into the aux file. +	\scanexp{% +	  \xdef\noexpand\gtemp{% +	    \ifx\thisshortcaption\empty +	      \thiscaption +	    \else +	      \thisshortcaption +	    \fi +	  }% +	}% +        \immediate\write\auxfile{@xrdef{\floatlabel-lof}{\floatident +	  \ifx\gtemp\empty \else : \gtemp \fi}}% +      }% +    \fi +  \egroup  % end of \vtop +  % +  % place the captured inserts +  % +  % BEWARE: when the floats start floating, we have to issue warning +  % whenever an insert appears inside a float which could possibly +  % float. --kasal, 26may04 +  % +  \checkinserts +} + +% Append the tokens #2 to the definition of macro #1, not expanding either. +% +\def\appendtomacro#1#2{% +  \expandafter\def\expandafter#1\expandafter{#1#2}% +} + +% @caption, @shortcaption +% +\def\caption{\docaption\thiscaption} +\def\shortcaption{\docaption\thisshortcaption} +\def\docaption{\checkenv\float \bgroup\scanargctxt\defcaption} +\def\defcaption#1#2{\egroup \def#1{#2}} + +% The parameter is the control sequence identifying the counter we are +% going to use.  Create it if it doesn't exist and assign it to \floatno. +\def\getfloatno#1{% +  \ifx#1\relax +      % Haven't seen this figure type before. +      \csname newcount\endcsname #1% +      % +      % Remember to reset this floatno at the next chap. +      \expandafter\gdef\expandafter\resetallfloatnos +        \expandafter{\resetallfloatnos #1=0 }% +  \fi +  \let\floatno#1% +} + +% \setref calls this to get the XREFLABEL-snt value.  We want an @xref +% to the FLOATLABEL to expand to "Figure 3.1".  We call \setref when we +% first read the @float command. +% +\def\Yfloat{\floattype@tie \chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}% + +% Magic string used for the XREFLABEL-title value, so \xrefX can +% distinguish floats from other xref types. +\def\floatmagic{!!float!!} + +% #1 is the control sequence we are passed; we expand into a conditional +% which is true if #1 represents a float ref.  That is, the magic +% \lastsection value which we \setref above. +% +\def\iffloat#1{\expandafter\doiffloat#1==\finish} +% +% #1 is (maybe) the \floatmagic string.  If so, #2 will be the +% (safe) float type for this float.  We set \iffloattype to #2. +% +\def\doiffloat#1=#2=#3\finish{% +  \def\temp{#1}% +  \def\iffloattype{#2}% +  \ifx\temp\floatmagic +} + +% @listoffloats FLOATTYPE - print a list of floats like a table of contents. +% +\parseargdef\listoffloats{% +  \def\floattype{#1}% floattype +  {% +    % the floattype might have accents or other special characters, +    % but we need to use it in a control sequence name. +    \indexnofonts +    \turnoffactive +    \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}% +  }% +  % +  % \xrdef saves the floats as a \do-list in \floatlistSAFEFLOATTYPE. +  \expandafter\ifx\csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname \relax +    \ifhavexrefs +      % if the user said @listoffloats foo but never @float foo. +      \message{\linenumber No `\safefloattype' floats to list.}% +    \fi +  \else +    \begingroup +      \leftskip=\tocindent  % indent these entries like a toc +      \let\do=\listoffloatsdo +      \csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname +    \endgroup +  \fi +} + +% This is called on each entry in a list of floats.  We're passed the +% xref label, in the form LABEL-title, which is how we save it in the +% aux file.  We strip off the -title and look up \XRLABEL-lof, which +% has the text we're supposed to typeset here. +% +% Figures without xref labels will not be included in the list (since +% they won't appear in the aux file). +% +\def\listoffloatsdo#1{\listoffloatsdoentry#1\finish} +\def\listoffloatsdoentry#1-title\finish{{% +  % Can't fully expand XR#1-lof because it can contain anything.  Just +  % pass the control sequence.  On the other hand, XR#1-pg is just the +  % page number, and we want to fully expand that so we can get a link +  % in pdf output. +  \toksA = \expandafter{\csname XR#1-lof\endcsname}% +  % +  % use the same \entry macro we use to generate the TOC and index. +  \edef\writeentry{\noexpand\entry{\the\toksA}{\csname XR#1-pg\endcsname}}% +  \writeentry +}} + + +\message{localization,} + +% For single-language documents, @documentlanguage is usually given very +% early, just after @documentencoding.  Single argument is the language +% (de) or locale (de_DE) abbreviation. +% +{ +  \catcode`\_ = \active +  \globaldefs=1 +\parseargdef\documentlanguage{\begingroup +  \let_=\normalunderscore  % normal _ character for filenames +  \tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX. +    % Read the file by the name they passed if it exists. +    \openin 1 txi-#1.tex +    \ifeof 1 +      \documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore{#1_\finish}% +    \else +      \globaldefs = 1  % everything in the txi-LL files needs to persist +      \input txi-#1.tex +    \fi +    \closein 1 +  \endgroup % end raw TeX +\endgroup} +% +% If they passed de_DE, and txi-de_DE.tex doesn't exist, +% try txi-de.tex. +% +\gdef\documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore#1_#2\finish{% +  \openin 1 txi-#1.tex +  \ifeof 1 +    \errhelp = \nolanghelp +    \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-#1.tex}% +  \else +    \globaldefs = 1  % everything in the txi-LL files needs to persist +    \input txi-#1.tex +  \fi +  \closein 1 +} +}% end of special _ catcode +% +\newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or +is empty.  Maybe you need to install it?  Putting it in the current +directory should work if nowhere else does.} + +% This macro is called from txi-??.tex files; the first argument is the +% \language name to set (without the "\lang@" prefix), the second and +% third args are \{left,right}hyphenmin. +% +% The language names to pass are determined when the format is built. +% See the etex.log file created at that time, e.g., +% /usr/local/texlive/2008/texmf-var/web2c/pdftex/etex.log. +% +% With TeX Live 2008, etex now includes hyphenation patterns for all +% available languages.  This means we can support hyphenation in +% Texinfo, at least to some extent.  (This still doesn't solve the +% accented characters problem.) +% +\catcode`@=11 +\def\txisetlanguage#1#2#3{% +  % do not set the language if the name is undefined in the current TeX. +  \expandafter\ifx\csname lang@#1\endcsname \relax +    \message{no patterns for #1}% +  \else +    \global\language = \csname lang@#1\endcsname +  \fi +  % but there is no harm in adjusting the hyphenmin values regardless. +  \global\lefthyphenmin = #2\relax +  \global\righthyphenmin = #3\relax +} + +% Helpers for encodings. +% Set the catcode of characters 128 through 255 to the specified number. +% +\def\setnonasciicharscatcode#1{% +   \count255=128 +   \loop\ifnum\count255<256 +      \global\catcode\count255=#1\relax +      \advance\count255 by 1 +   \repeat +} + +\def\setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal#1{% +   \count255=128 +   \loop\ifnum\count255<256 +      \catcode\count255=#1\relax +      \advance\count255 by 1 +   \repeat +} + +% @documentencoding sets the definition of non-ASCII characters +% according to the specified encoding. +% +\parseargdef\documentencoding{% +  % Encoding being declared for the document. +  \def\declaredencoding{\csname #1.enc\endcsname}% +  % +  % Supported encodings: names converted to tokens in order to be able +  % to compare them with \ifx. +  \def\ascii{\csname US-ASCII.enc\endcsname}% +  \def\latnine{\csname ISO-8859-15.enc\endcsname}% +  \def\latone{\csname ISO-8859-1.enc\endcsname}% +  \def\lattwo{\csname ISO-8859-2.enc\endcsname}% +  \def\utfeight{\csname UTF-8.enc\endcsname}% +  % +  \ifx \declaredencoding \ascii +     \asciichardefs +  % +  \else \ifx \declaredencoding \lattwo +     \setnonasciicharscatcode\active +     \lattwochardefs +  % +  \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latone +     \setnonasciicharscatcode\active +     \latonechardefs +  % +  \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latnine +     \setnonasciicharscatcode\active +     \latninechardefs +  % +  \else \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight +     \setnonasciicharscatcode\active +     \utfeightchardefs +  % +  \else +    \message{Unknown document encoding #1, ignoring.}% +  % +  \fi % utfeight +  \fi % latnine +  \fi % latone +  \fi % lattwo +  \fi % ascii +} + +% A message to be logged when using a character that isn't available +% the default font encoding (OT1). +% +\def\missingcharmsg#1{\message{Character missing in OT1 encoding: #1.}} + +% Take account of \c (plain) vs. \, (Texinfo) difference. +\def\cedilla#1{\ifx\c\ptexc\c{#1}\else\,{#1}\fi} + +% First, make active non-ASCII characters in order for them to be +% correctly categorized when TeX reads the replacement text of +% macros containing the character definitions. +\setnonasciicharscatcode\active +% +% Latin1 (ISO-8859-1) character definitions. +\def\latonechardefs{% +  \gdef^^a0{\tie} +  \gdef^^a1{\exclamdown} +  \gdef^^a2{\missingcharmsg{CENT SIGN}} +  \gdef^^a3{{\pounds}} +  \gdef^^a4{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN}} +  \gdef^^a5{\missingcharmsg{YEN SIGN}} +  \gdef^^a6{\missingcharmsg{BROKEN BAR}} +  \gdef^^a7{\S} +  \gdef^^a8{\"{}} +  \gdef^^a9{\copyright} +  \gdef^^aa{\ordf} +  \gdef^^ab{\guillemetleft} +  \gdef^^ac{$\lnot$} +  \gdef^^ad{\-} +  \gdef^^ae{\registeredsymbol} +  \gdef^^af{\={}} +  % +  \gdef^^b0{\textdegree} +  \gdef^^b1{$\pm$} +  \gdef^^b2{$^2$} +  \gdef^^b3{$^3$} +  \gdef^^b4{\'{}} +  \gdef^^b5{$\mu$} +  \gdef^^b6{\P} +  % +  \gdef^^b7{$^.$} +  \gdef^^b8{\cedilla\ } +  \gdef^^b9{$^1$} +  \gdef^^ba{\ordm} +  % +  \gdef^^bb{\guillemetright} +  \gdef^^bc{$1\over4$} +  \gdef^^bd{$1\over2$} +  \gdef^^be{$3\over4$} +  \gdef^^bf{\questiondown} +  % +  \gdef^^c0{\`A} +  \gdef^^c1{\'A} +  \gdef^^c2{\^A} +  \gdef^^c3{\~A} +  \gdef^^c4{\"A} +  \gdef^^c5{\ringaccent A} +  \gdef^^c6{\AE} +  \gdef^^c7{\cedilla C} +  \gdef^^c8{\`E} +  \gdef^^c9{\'E} +  \gdef^^ca{\^E} +  \gdef^^cb{\"E} +  \gdef^^cc{\`I} +  \gdef^^cd{\'I} +  \gdef^^ce{\^I} +  \gdef^^cf{\"I} +  % +  \gdef^^d0{\DH} +  \gdef^^d1{\~N} +  \gdef^^d2{\`O} +  \gdef^^d3{\'O} +  \gdef^^d4{\^O} +  \gdef^^d5{\~O} +  \gdef^^d6{\"O} +  \gdef^^d7{$\times$} +  \gdef^^d8{\O} +  \gdef^^d9{\`U} +  \gdef^^da{\'U} +  \gdef^^db{\^U} +  \gdef^^dc{\"U} +  \gdef^^dd{\'Y} +  \gdef^^de{\TH} +  \gdef^^df{\ss} +  % +  \gdef^^e0{\`a} +  \gdef^^e1{\'a} +  \gdef^^e2{\^a} +  \gdef^^e3{\~a} +  \gdef^^e4{\"a} +  \gdef^^e5{\ringaccent a} +  \gdef^^e6{\ae} +  \gdef^^e7{\cedilla c} +  \gdef^^e8{\`e} +  \gdef^^e9{\'e} +  \gdef^^ea{\^e} +  \gdef^^eb{\"e} +  \gdef^^ec{\`{\dotless i}} +  \gdef^^ed{\'{\dotless i}} +  \gdef^^ee{\^{\dotless i}} +  \gdef^^ef{\"{\dotless i}} +  % +  \gdef^^f0{\dh} +  \gdef^^f1{\~n} +  \gdef^^f2{\`o} +  \gdef^^f3{\'o} +  \gdef^^f4{\^o} +  \gdef^^f5{\~o} +  \gdef^^f6{\"o} +  \gdef^^f7{$\div$} +  \gdef^^f8{\o} +  \gdef^^f9{\`u} +  \gdef^^fa{\'u} +  \gdef^^fb{\^u} +  \gdef^^fc{\"u} +  \gdef^^fd{\'y} +  \gdef^^fe{\th} +  \gdef^^ff{\"y} +} + +% Latin9 (ISO-8859-15) encoding character definitions. +\def\latninechardefs{% +  % Encoding is almost identical to Latin1. +  \latonechardefs +  % +  \gdef^^a4{\euro} +  \gdef^^a6{\v S} +  \gdef^^a8{\v s} +  \gdef^^b4{\v Z} +  \gdef^^b8{\v z} +  \gdef^^bc{\OE} +  \gdef^^bd{\oe} +  \gdef^^be{\"Y} +} + +% Latin2 (ISO-8859-2) character definitions. +\def\lattwochardefs{% +  \gdef^^a0{\tie} +  \gdef^^a1{\ogonek{A}} +  \gdef^^a2{\u{}} +  \gdef^^a3{\L} +  \gdef^^a4{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN}} +  \gdef^^a5{\v L} +  \gdef^^a6{\'S} +  \gdef^^a7{\S} +  \gdef^^a8{\"{}} +  \gdef^^a9{\v S} +  \gdef^^aa{\cedilla S} +  \gdef^^ab{\v T} +  \gdef^^ac{\'Z} +  \gdef^^ad{\-} +  \gdef^^ae{\v Z} +  \gdef^^af{\dotaccent Z} +  % +  \gdef^^b0{\textdegree} +  \gdef^^b1{\ogonek{a}} +  \gdef^^b2{\ogonek{ }} +  \gdef^^b3{\l} +  \gdef^^b4{\'{}} +  \gdef^^b5{\v l} +  \gdef^^b6{\'s} +  \gdef^^b7{\v{}} +  \gdef^^b8{\cedilla\ } +  \gdef^^b9{\v s} +  \gdef^^ba{\cedilla s} +  \gdef^^bb{\v t} +  \gdef^^bc{\'z} +  \gdef^^bd{\H{}} +  \gdef^^be{\v z} +  \gdef^^bf{\dotaccent z} +  % +  \gdef^^c0{\'R} +  \gdef^^c1{\'A} +  \gdef^^c2{\^A} +  \gdef^^c3{\u A} +  \gdef^^c4{\"A} +  \gdef^^c5{\'L} +  \gdef^^c6{\'C} +  \gdef^^c7{\cedilla C} +  \gdef^^c8{\v C} +  \gdef^^c9{\'E} +  \gdef^^ca{\ogonek{E}} +  \gdef^^cb{\"E} +  \gdef^^cc{\v E} +  \gdef^^cd{\'I} +  \gdef^^ce{\^I} +  \gdef^^cf{\v D} +  % +  \gdef^^d0{\DH} +  \gdef^^d1{\'N} +  \gdef^^d2{\v N} +  \gdef^^d3{\'O} +  \gdef^^d4{\^O} +  \gdef^^d5{\H O} +  \gdef^^d6{\"O} +  \gdef^^d7{$\times$} +  \gdef^^d8{\v R} +  \gdef^^d9{\ringaccent U} +  \gdef^^da{\'U} +  \gdef^^db{\H U} +  \gdef^^dc{\"U} +  \gdef^^dd{\'Y} +  \gdef^^de{\cedilla T} +  \gdef^^df{\ss} +  % +  \gdef^^e0{\'r} +  \gdef^^e1{\'a} +  \gdef^^e2{\^a} +  \gdef^^e3{\u a} +  \gdef^^e4{\"a} +  \gdef^^e5{\'l} +  \gdef^^e6{\'c} +  \gdef^^e7{\cedilla c} +  \gdef^^e8{\v c} +  \gdef^^e9{\'e} +  \gdef^^ea{\ogonek{e}} +  \gdef^^eb{\"e} +  \gdef^^ec{\v e} +  \gdef^^ed{\'{\dotless{i}}} +  \gdef^^ee{\^{\dotless{i}}} +  \gdef^^ef{\v d} +  % +  \gdef^^f0{\dh} +  \gdef^^f1{\'n} +  \gdef^^f2{\v n} +  \gdef^^f3{\'o} +  \gdef^^f4{\^o} +  \gdef^^f5{\H o} +  \gdef^^f6{\"o} +  \gdef^^f7{$\div$} +  \gdef^^f8{\v r} +  \gdef^^f9{\ringaccent u} +  \gdef^^fa{\'u} +  \gdef^^fb{\H u} +  \gdef^^fc{\"u} +  \gdef^^fd{\'y} +  \gdef^^fe{\cedilla t} +  \gdef^^ff{\dotaccent{}} +} + +% UTF-8 character definitions. +% +% This code to support UTF-8 is based on LaTeX's utf8.def, with some +% changes for Texinfo conventions.  It is included here under the GPL by +% permission from Frank Mittelbach and the LaTeX team. +% +\newcount\countUTFx +\newcount\countUTFy +\newcount\countUTFz + +\gdef\UTFviiiTwoOctets#1#2{\expandafter +   \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\endcsname} +% +\gdef\UTFviiiThreeOctets#1#2#3{\expandafter +   \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\endcsname} +% +\gdef\UTFviiiFourOctets#1#2#3#4{\expandafter +   \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\string #4\endcsname} + +\gdef\UTFviiiDefined#1{% +  \ifx #1\relax +    \message{\linenumber Unicode char \string #1 not defined for Texinfo}% +  \else +    \expandafter #1% +  \fi +} + +\begingroup +  \catcode`\~13 +  \catcode`\"12 + +  \def\UTFviiiLoop{% +    \global\catcode\countUTFx\active +    \uccode`\~\countUTFx +    \uppercase\expandafter{\UTFviiiTmp}% +    \advance\countUTFx by 1 +    \ifnum\countUTFx < \countUTFy +      \expandafter\UTFviiiLoop +    \fi} + +  \countUTFx = "C2 +  \countUTFy = "E0 +  \def\UTFviiiTmp{% +    \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiTwoOctets\string~}} +  \UTFviiiLoop + +  \countUTFx = "E0 +  \countUTFy = "F0 +  \def\UTFviiiTmp{% +    \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiThreeOctets\string~}} +  \UTFviiiLoop + +  \countUTFx = "F0 +  \countUTFy = "F4 +  \def\UTFviiiTmp{% +    \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiFourOctets\string~}} +  \UTFviiiLoop +\endgroup + +\begingroup +  \catcode`\"=12 +  \catcode`\<=12 +  \catcode`\.=12 +  \catcode`\,=12 +  \catcode`\;=12 +  \catcode`\!=12 +  \catcode`\~=13 + +  \gdef\DeclareUnicodeCharacter#1#2{% +    \countUTFz = "#1\relax +    %\wlog{\space\space defining Unicode char U+#1 (decimal \the\countUTFz)}% +    \begingroup +      \parseXMLCharref +      \def\UTFviiiTwoOctets##1##2{% +        \csname u8:##1\string ##2\endcsname}% +      \def\UTFviiiThreeOctets##1##2##3{% +        \csname u8:##1\string ##2\string ##3\endcsname}% +      \def\UTFviiiFourOctets##1##2##3##4{% +        \csname u8:##1\string ##2\string ##3\string ##4\endcsname}% +      \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\expandafter +       \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter +       \gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2}% +    \endgroup} + +  \gdef\parseXMLCharref{% +    \ifnum\countUTFz < "A0\relax +      \errhelp = \EMsimple +      \errmessage{Cannot define Unicode char value < 00A0}% +    \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "800\relax +      \parseUTFviiiA,% +      \parseUTFviiiB C\UTFviiiTwoOctets.,% +    \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "10000\relax +      \parseUTFviiiA;% +      \parseUTFviiiA,% +      \parseUTFviiiB E\UTFviiiThreeOctets.{,;}% +    \else +      \parseUTFviiiA;% +      \parseUTFviiiA,% +      \parseUTFviiiA!% +      \parseUTFviiiB F\UTFviiiFourOctets.{!,;}% +    \fi\fi\fi +  } + +  \gdef\parseUTFviiiA#1{% +    \countUTFx = \countUTFz +    \divide\countUTFz by 64 +    \countUTFy = \countUTFz +    \multiply\countUTFz by 64 +    \advance\countUTFx by -\countUTFz +    \advance\countUTFx by 128 +    \uccode `#1\countUTFx +    \countUTFz = \countUTFy} + +  \gdef\parseUTFviiiB#1#2#3#4{% +    \advance\countUTFz by "#10\relax +    \uccode `#3\countUTFz +    \uppercase{\gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2#3#4}}} +\endgroup + +\def\utfeightchardefs{% +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A0}{\tie} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A1}{\exclamdown} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A3}{\pounds} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A8}{\"{ }} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A9}{\copyright} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AA}{\ordf} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AB}{\guillemetleft} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AD}{\-} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AE}{\registeredsymbol} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AF}{\={ }} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B0}{\ringaccent{ }} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B4}{\'{ }} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B8}{\cedilla{ }} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BA}{\ordm} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BB}{\guillemetright} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BF}{\questiondown} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C0}{\`A} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C1}{\'A} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C2}{\^A} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C3}{\~A} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C4}{\"A} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C5}{\AA} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C6}{\AE} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C7}{\cedilla{C}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C8}{\`E} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C9}{\'E} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CA}{\^E} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CB}{\"E} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CC}{\`I} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CD}{\'I} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CE}{\^I} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CF}{\"I} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D0}{\DH} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D1}{\~N} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D2}{\`O} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D3}{\'O} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D4}{\^O} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D5}{\~O} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D6}{\"O} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D8}{\O} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D9}{\`U} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DA}{\'U} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DB}{\^U} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DC}{\"U} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DD}{\'Y} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DE}{\TH} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DF}{\ss} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E0}{\`a} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E1}{\'a} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E2}{\^a} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E3}{\~a} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E4}{\"a} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E5}{\aa} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E6}{\ae} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E7}{\cedilla{c}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E8}{\`e} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E9}{\'e} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EA}{\^e} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EB}{\"e} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EC}{\`{\dotless{i}}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00ED}{\'{\dotless{i}}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EE}{\^{\dotless{i}}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EF}{\"{\dotless{i}}} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F0}{\dh} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F1}{\~n} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F2}{\`o} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F3}{\'o} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F4}{\^o} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F5}{\~o} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F6}{\"o} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F8}{\o} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F9}{\`u} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FA}{\'u} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FB}{\^u} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FC}{\"u} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FD}{\'y} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FE}{\th} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FF}{\"y} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0100}{\=A} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0101}{\=a} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0102}{\u{A}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0103}{\u{a}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0104}{\ogonek{A}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0105}{\ogonek{a}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0106}{\'C} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0107}{\'c} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0108}{\^C} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0109}{\^c} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0118}{\ogonek{E}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0119}{\ogonek{e}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010A}{\dotaccent{C}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010B}{\dotaccent{c}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010C}{\v{C}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010D}{\v{c}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010E}{\v{D}} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0112}{\=E} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0113}{\=e} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0114}{\u{E}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0115}{\u{e}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0116}{\dotaccent{E}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0117}{\dotaccent{e}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011A}{\v{E}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011B}{\v{e}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011C}{\^G} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011D}{\^g} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011E}{\u{G}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011F}{\u{g}} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0120}{\dotaccent{G}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0121}{\dotaccent{g}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0124}{\^H} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0125}{\^h} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0128}{\~I} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0129}{\~{\dotless{i}}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012A}{\=I} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012B}{\={\dotless{i}}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012C}{\u{I}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012D}{\u{\dotless{i}}} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0130}{\dotaccent{I}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0131}{\dotless{i}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0132}{IJ} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0133}{ij} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0134}{\^J} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0135}{\^{\dotless{j}}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0139}{\'L} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013A}{\'l} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0141}{\L} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0142}{\l} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0143}{\'N} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0144}{\'n} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0147}{\v{N}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0148}{\v{n}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014C}{\=O} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014D}{\=o} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014E}{\u{O}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014F}{\u{o}} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0150}{\H{O}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0151}{\H{o}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0152}{\OE} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0153}{\oe} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0154}{\'R} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0155}{\'r} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0158}{\v{R}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0159}{\v{r}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015A}{\'S} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015B}{\'s} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015C}{\^S} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015D}{\^s} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015E}{\cedilla{S}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015F}{\cedilla{s}} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0160}{\v{S}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0161}{\v{s}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0162}{\cedilla{t}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0163}{\cedilla{T}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0164}{\v{T}} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0168}{\~U} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0169}{\~u} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016A}{\=U} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016B}{\=u} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016C}{\u{U}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016D}{\u{u}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016E}{\ringaccent{U}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016F}{\ringaccent{u}} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0170}{\H{U}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0171}{\H{u}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0174}{\^W} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0175}{\^w} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0176}{\^Y} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0177}{\^y} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0178}{\"Y} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0179}{\'Z} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017A}{\'z} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017B}{\dotaccent{Z}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017C}{\dotaccent{z}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017D}{\v{Z}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017E}{\v{z}} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C4}{D\v{Z}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C5}{D\v{z}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C6}{d\v{z}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C7}{LJ} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C8}{Lj} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C9}{lj} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CA}{NJ} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CB}{Nj} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CC}{nj} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CD}{\v{A}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CE}{\v{a}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CF}{\v{I}} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D0}{\v{\dotless{i}}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D1}{\v{O}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D2}{\v{o}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D3}{\v{U}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D4}{\v{u}} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E2}{\={\AE}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E3}{\={\ae}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E6}{\v{G}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E7}{\v{g}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E8}{\v{K}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E9}{\v{k}} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F0}{\v{\dotless{j}}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F1}{DZ} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F2}{Dz} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F3}{dz} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F4}{\'G} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F5}{\'g} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F8}{\`N} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F9}{\`n} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FC}{\'{\AE}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FD}{\'{\ae}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FE}{\'{\O}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FF}{\'{\o}} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021E}{\v{H}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021F}{\v{h}} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0226}{\dotaccent{A}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0227}{\dotaccent{a}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0228}{\cedilla{E}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0229}{\cedilla{e}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022E}{\dotaccent{O}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022F}{\dotaccent{o}} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0232}{\=Y} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0233}{\=y} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0237}{\dotless{j}} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{02DB}{\ogonek{ }} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E02}{\dotaccent{B}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E03}{\dotaccent{b}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E04}{\udotaccent{B}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E05}{\udotaccent{b}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E06}{\ubaraccent{B}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E07}{\ubaraccent{b}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0A}{\dotaccent{D}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0B}{\dotaccent{d}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0C}{\udotaccent{D}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0D}{\udotaccent{d}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0E}{\ubaraccent{D}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0F}{\ubaraccent{d}} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1E}{\dotaccent{F}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1F}{\dotaccent{f}} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E20}{\=G} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E21}{\=g} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E22}{\dotaccent{H}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E23}{\dotaccent{h}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E24}{\udotaccent{H}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E25}{\udotaccent{h}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E26}{\"H} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E27}{\"h} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E30}{\'K} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E31}{\'k} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E32}{\udotaccent{K}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E33}{\udotaccent{k}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E34}{\ubaraccent{K}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E35}{\ubaraccent{k}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E36}{\udotaccent{L}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E37}{\udotaccent{l}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3A}{\ubaraccent{L}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3B}{\ubaraccent{l}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3E}{\'M} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3F}{\'m} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E40}{\dotaccent{M}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E41}{\dotaccent{m}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E42}{\udotaccent{M}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E43}{\udotaccent{m}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E44}{\dotaccent{N}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E45}{\dotaccent{n}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E46}{\udotaccent{N}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E47}{\udotaccent{n}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E48}{\ubaraccent{N}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E49}{\ubaraccent{n}} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E54}{\'P} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E55}{\'p} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E56}{\dotaccent{P}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E57}{\dotaccent{p}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E58}{\dotaccent{R}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E59}{\dotaccent{r}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5A}{\udotaccent{R}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5B}{\udotaccent{r}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5E}{\ubaraccent{R}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5F}{\ubaraccent{r}} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E60}{\dotaccent{S}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E61}{\dotaccent{s}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E62}{\udotaccent{S}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E63}{\udotaccent{s}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6A}{\dotaccent{T}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6B}{\dotaccent{t}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6C}{\udotaccent{T}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6D}{\udotaccent{t}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6E}{\ubaraccent{T}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6F}{\ubaraccent{t}} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7C}{\~V} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7D}{\~v} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7E}{\udotaccent{V}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7F}{\udotaccent{v}} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E80}{\`W} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E81}{\`w} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E82}{\'W} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E83}{\'w} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E84}{\"W} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E85}{\"w} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E86}{\dotaccent{W}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E87}{\dotaccent{w}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E88}{\udotaccent{W}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E89}{\udotaccent{w}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8A}{\dotaccent{X}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8B}{\dotaccent{x}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8C}{\"X} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8D}{\"x} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8E}{\dotaccent{Y}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8F}{\dotaccent{y}} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E90}{\^Z} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E91}{\^z} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E92}{\udotaccent{Z}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E93}{\udotaccent{z}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E94}{\ubaraccent{Z}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E95}{\ubaraccent{z}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E96}{\ubaraccent{h}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E97}{\"t} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E98}{\ringaccent{w}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E99}{\ringaccent{y}} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA0}{\udotaccent{A}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA1}{\udotaccent{a}} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB8}{\udotaccent{E}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB9}{\udotaccent{e}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBC}{\~E} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBD}{\~e} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECA}{\udotaccent{I}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECB}{\udotaccent{i}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECC}{\udotaccent{O}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECD}{\udotaccent{o}} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE4}{\udotaccent{U}} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE5}{\udotaccent{u}} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF2}{\`Y} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF3}{\`y} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF4}{\udotaccent{Y}} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF8}{\~Y} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF9}{\~y} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2013}{--} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2014}{---} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2018}{\quoteleft} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2019}{\quoteright} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201A}{\quotesinglbase} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201C}{\quotedblleft} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201D}{\quotedblright} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201E}{\quotedblbase} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2022}{\bullet} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2026}{\dots} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2039}{\guilsinglleft} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{203A}{\guilsinglright} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{20AC}{\euro} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2192}{\expansion} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D2}{\result} + +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2212}{\minus} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2217}{\point} +  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2261}{\equiv} +}% end of \utfeightchardefs + + +% US-ASCII character definitions. +\def\asciichardefs{% nothing need be done +   \relax +} + +% Make non-ASCII characters printable again for compatibility with +% existing Texinfo documents that may use them, even without declaring a +% document encoding. +% +\setnonasciicharscatcode \other + + +\message{formatting,} + +\newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent = 15pt + +\chapheadingskip = 15pt plus 4pt minus 2pt +\secheadingskip = 12pt plus 3pt minus 2pt +\subsecheadingskip = 9pt plus 2pt minus 2pt + +% Prevent underfull vbox error messages. +\vbadness = 10000 + +% Don't be very finicky about underfull hboxes, either. +\hbadness = 6666 + +% Following George Bush, get rid of widows and orphans. +\widowpenalty=10000 +\clubpenalty=10000 + +% Use TeX 3.0's \emergencystretch to help line breaking, but if we're +% using an old version of TeX, don't do anything.  We want the amount of +% stretch added to depend on the line length, hence the dependence on +% \hsize.  We call this whenever the paper size is set. +% +\def\setemergencystretch{% +  \ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined +    % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway. +    \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}% +  \else +    \emergencystretch = .15\hsize +  \fi +} + +% Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth; +% 3) voffset; 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip; +% 7) physical page height; 8) physical page width. +% +% We also call \setleading{\textleading}, so the caller should define +% \textleading.  The caller should also set \parskip. +% +\def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6#7#8{% +  \voffset = #3\relax +  \topskip = #6\relax +  \splittopskip = \topskip +  % +  \vsize = #1\relax +  \advance\vsize by \topskip +  \outervsize = \vsize +  \advance\outervsize by 2\topandbottommargin +  \pageheight = \vsize +  % +  \hsize = #2\relax +  \outerhsize = \hsize +  \advance\outerhsize by 0.5in +  \pagewidth = \hsize +  % +  \normaloffset = #4\relax +  \bindingoffset = #5\relax +  % +  \ifpdf +    \pdfpageheight #7\relax +    \pdfpagewidth #8\relax +    % if we don't reset these, they will remain at "1 true in" of +    % whatever layout pdftex was dumped with. +    \pdfhorigin = 1 true in +    \pdfvorigin = 1 true in +  \fi +  % +  \setleading{\textleading} +  % +  \parindent = \defaultparindent +  \setemergencystretch +} + +% @letterpaper (the default). +\def\letterpaper{{\globaldefs = 1 +  \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt +  \textleading = 13.2pt +  % +  % If page is nothing but text, make it come out even. +  \internalpagesizes{607.2pt}{6in}% that's 46 lines +                    {\voffset}{.25in}% +                    {\bindingoffset}{36pt}% +                    {11in}{8.5in}% +}} + +% Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.25 trim size. +\def\smallbook{{\globaldefs = 1 +  \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt +  \textleading = 12pt +  % +  \internalpagesizes{7.5in}{5in}% +                    {-.2in}{0in}% +                    {\bindingoffset}{16pt}% +                    {9.25in}{7in}% +  % +  \lispnarrowing = 0.3in +  \tolerance = 700 +  \hfuzz = 1pt +  \contentsrightmargin = 0pt +  \defbodyindent = .5cm +}} + +% Use @smallerbook to reset parameters for 6x9 trim size. +% (Just testing, parameters still in flux.) +\def\smallerbook{{\globaldefs = 1 +  \parskip = 1.5pt plus 1pt +  \textleading = 12pt +  % +  \internalpagesizes{7.4in}{4.8in}% +                    {-.2in}{-.4in}% +                    {0pt}{14pt}% +                    {9in}{6in}% +  % +  \lispnarrowing = 0.25in +  \tolerance = 700 +  \hfuzz = 1pt +  \contentsrightmargin = 0pt +  \defbodyindent = .4cm +}} + +% Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper. +\def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs = 1 +  \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt +  \textleading = 13.2pt +  % +  % Double-side printing via postscript on Laserjet 4050 +  % prints double-sided nicely when \bindingoffset=10mm and \hoffset=-6mm. +  % To change the settings for a different printer or situation, adjust +  % \normaloffset until the front-side and back-side texts align.  Then +  % do the same for \bindingoffset.  You can set these for testing in +  % your texinfo source file like this: +  % @tex +  % \global\normaloffset = -6mm +  % \global\bindingoffset = 10mm +  % @end tex +  \internalpagesizes{673.2pt}{160mm}% that's 51 lines +                    {\voffset}{\hoffset}% +                    {\bindingoffset}{44pt}% +                    {297mm}{210mm}% +  % +  \tolerance = 700 +  \hfuzz = 1pt +  \contentsrightmargin = 0pt +  \defbodyindent = 5mm +}} + +% Use @afivepaper to print on European A5 paper. +% From [email protected], 2 July 2000. +% He also recommends making @example and @lisp be small. +\def\afivepaper{{\globaldefs = 1 +  \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt minus 0.1pt +  \textleading = 12.5pt +  % +  \internalpagesizes{160mm}{120mm}% +                    {\voffset}{\hoffset}% +                    {\bindingoffset}{8pt}% +                    {210mm}{148mm}% +  % +  \lispnarrowing = 0.2in +  \tolerance = 800 +  \hfuzz = 1.2pt +  \contentsrightmargin = 0pt +  \defbodyindent = 2mm +  \tableindent = 12mm +}} + +% A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper. +\def\afourlatex{{\globaldefs = 1 +  \afourpaper +  \internalpagesizes{237mm}{150mm}% +                    {\voffset}{4.6mm}% +                    {\bindingoffset}{7mm}% +                    {297mm}{210mm}% +  % +  % Must explicitly reset to 0 because we call \afourpaper. +  \globaldefs = 0 +}} + +% Use @afourwide to print on A4 paper in landscape format. +\def\afourwide{{\globaldefs = 1 +  \afourpaper +  \internalpagesizes{241mm}{165mm}% +                    {\voffset}{-2.95mm}% +                    {\bindingoffset}{7mm}% +                    {297mm}{210mm}% +  \globaldefs = 0 +}} + +% @pagesizes TEXTHEIGHT[,TEXTWIDTH] +% Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip, +% and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow. +% +\parseargdef\pagesizes{\pagesizesyyy #1,,\finish} +\def\pagesizesyyy#1,#2,#3\finish{{% +  \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \hsize=#2\relax \fi +  \globaldefs = 1 +  % +  \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt +  \setleading{\textleading}% +  % +  \dimen0 = #1\relax +  \advance\dimen0 by \voffset +  % +  \dimen2 = \hsize +  \advance\dimen2 by \normaloffset +  % +  \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}% +                    {\voffset}{\normaloffset}% +                    {\bindingoffset}{44pt}% +                    {\dimen0}{\dimen2}% +}} + +% Set default to letter. +% +\letterpaper + + +\message{and turning on texinfo input format.} + +\def^^L{\par} % remove \outer, so ^L can appear in an @comment + +% DEL is a comment character, in case @c does not suffice. +\catcode`\^^? = 14 + +% Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text. +\catcode`\"=\other \def\normaldoublequote{"} +\catcode`\$=\other \def\normaldollar{$}%$ font-lock fix +\catcode`\+=\other \def\normalplus{+} +\catcode`\<=\other \def\normalless{<} +\catcode`\>=\other \def\normalgreater{>} +\catcode`\^=\other \def\normalcaret{^} +\catcode`\_=\other \def\normalunderscore{_} +\catcode`\|=\other \def\normalverticalbar{|} +\catcode`\~=\other \def\normaltilde{~} + +% This macro is used to make a character print one way in \tt +% (where it can probably be output as-is), and another way in other fonts, +% where something hairier probably needs to be done. +% +% #1 is what to print if we are indeed using \tt; #2 is what to print +% otherwise.  Since all the Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero +% interword stretch (and shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all +% typewriter fonts to have this, we can check that font parameter. +% +\def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\font=0pt #1\else #2\fi} + +% Same as above, but check for italic font.  Actually this also catches +% non-italic slanted fonts since it is impossible to distinguish them from +% italic fonts.  But since this is only used by $ and it uses \sl anyway +% this is not a problem. +\def\ifusingit#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen1\font>0pt #1\else #2\fi} + +% Turn off all special characters except @ +% (and those which the user can use as if they were ordinary). +% Most of these we simply print from the \tt font, but for some, we can +% use math or other variants that look better in normal text. + +\catcode`\"=\active +\def\activedoublequote{{\tt\char34}} +\let"=\activedoublequote +\catcode`\~=\active +\def~{{\tt\char126}} +\chardef\hat=`\^ +\catcode`\^=\active +\def^{{\tt \hat}} + +\catcode`\_=\active +\def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_} +\let\realunder=_ +% Subroutine for the previous macro. +\def\_{\leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em } + +\catcode`\|=\active +\def|{{\tt\char124}} +\chardef \less=`\< +\catcode`\<=\active +\def<{{\tt \less}} +\chardef \gtr=`\> +\catcode`\>=\active +\def>{{\tt \gtr}} +\catcode`\+=\active +\def+{{\tt \char 43}} +\catcode`\$=\active +\def${\ifusingit{{\sl\$}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix + +% If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file +% name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line. +% So turn them off again, and have \everyjob (or @setfilename) turn them on. +% \otherifyactive is called near the end of this file. +\def\otherifyactive{\catcode`+=\other \catcode`\_=\other} + +% Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters even after +% parsing them. +\def\turnoffactive{% +  \normalturnoffactive +  \otherbackslash +} + +\catcode`\@=0 + +% \backslashcurfont outputs one backslash character in current font, +% as in \char`\\. +\global\chardef\backslashcurfont=`\\ +\global\let\rawbackslashxx=\backslashcurfont  % let existing .??s files work + +% \realbackslash is an actual character `\' with catcode other, and +% \doublebackslash is two of them (for the pdf outlines). +{\catcode`\\=\other @gdef@realbackslash{\} @gdef@doublebackslash{\\}} + +% In texinfo, backslash is an active character; it prints the backslash +% in fixed width font. +\catcode`\\=\active  % @ for escape char from now on. + +% The story here is that in math mode, the \char of \backslashcurfont +% ends up printing the roman \ from the math symbol font (because \char +% in math mode uses the \mathcode, and plain.tex sets +% \mathcode`\\="026E).  It seems better for @backslashchar{} to always +% print a typewriter backslash, hence we use an explicit \mathchar, +% which is the decimal equivalent of "715c (class 7, e.g., use \fam; +% ignored family value; char position "5C).  We can't use " for the +% usual hex value because it has already been made active. +@def@normalbackslash{{@tt @ifmmode @mathchar29020 @else @backslashcurfont @fi}} +@let@backslashchar = @normalbackslash % @backslashchar{} is for user documents. + +% On startup, @fixbackslash assigns: +%  @let \ = @normalbackslash +% \rawbackslash defines an active \ to do \backslashcurfont. +% \otherbackslash defines an active \ to be a literal `\' character with +% catcode other.  We switch back and forth between these. +@gdef@rawbackslash{@let\=@backslashcurfont} +@gdef@otherbackslash{@let\=@realbackslash} + +% Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of +% the literal character `\'.  Also revert - to its normal character, in +% case the active - from code has slipped in. +% +{@catcode`- = @active + @gdef@normalturnoffactive{% +   @let-=@normaldash +   @let"=@normaldoublequote +   @let$=@normaldollar %$ font-lock fix +   @let+=@normalplus +   @let<=@normalless +   @let>=@normalgreater +   @let\=@normalbackslash +   @let^=@normalcaret +   @let_=@normalunderscore +   @let|=@normalverticalbar +   @let~=@normaltilde +   @markupsetuplqdefault +   @markupsetuprqdefault +   @unsepspaces + } +} + +% Make _ and + \other characters, temporarily. +% This is canceled by @fixbackslash. +@otherifyactive + +% If a .fmt file is being used, we don't want the `\input texinfo' to show up. +% That is what \eatinput is for; after that, the `\' should revert to printing +% a backslash. +% +@gdef@eatinput input texinfo{@fixbackslash} +@global@let\ = @eatinput + +% On the other hand, perhaps the file did not have a `\input texinfo'. Then +% the first `\' in the file would cause an error. This macro tries to fix +% that, assuming it is called before the first `\' could plausibly occur. +% Also turn back on active characters that might appear in the input +% file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format. +% +@gdef@fixbackslash{% +  @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @normalbackslash @fi +  @catcode`+=@active +  @catcode`@_=@active +} + +% Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages. +@escapechar = `@@ + +% These (along with & and #) are made active for url-breaking, so need +% active definitions as the normal characters. +@def@normaldot{.} +@def@normalquest{?} +@def@normalslash{/} + +% These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special. +% @hashchar{} gets its own user-level command, because of #line. +@catcode`@& = @other @def@normalamp{&} +@catcode`@# = @other @def@normalhash{#} +@catcode`@% = @other @def@normalpercent{%} + +@let @hashchar = @normalhash + +@c Finally, make ` and ' active, so that txicodequoteundirected and +@c txicodequotebacktick work right in, e.g., @w{@code{`foo'}}.  If we +@c don't make ` and ' active, @code will not get them as active chars. +@c Do this last of all since we use ` in the previous @catcode assignments. +@catcode`@'=@active +@catcode`@`=@active +@markupsetuplqdefault +@markupsetuprqdefault + +@c Local variables: +@c eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp) +@c page-delimiter: "^\\\\message" +@c time-stamp-start: "def\\\\texinfoversion{" +@c time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H" +@c time-stamp-end: "}" +@c End: + +@c vim:sw=2: + +@ignore +   arch-tag: e1b36e32-c96e-4135-a41a-0b2efa2ea115 +@end ignore | 
